Add some more casts (1/2)
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "gdb.h"
48 #include "ui-out.h"
49 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
50 #include "block.h"
51 #include "solib.h"
52 #include "solist.h"
53 #include "observer.h"
54 #include "memattr.h"
55 #include "ada-lang.h"
56 #include "top.h"
57 #include "valprint.h"
58 #include "jit.h"
59 #include "parser-defs.h"
60 #include "gdb_regex.h"
61 #include "probe.h"
62 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
63 #include "continuations.h"
64 #include "stack.h"
65 #include "skip.h"
66 #include "ax-gdb.h"
67 #include "dummy-frame.h"
68 #include "interps.h"
69 #include "format.h"
70 #include "location.h"
71 #include "thread-fsm.h"
72
73 /* readline include files */
74 #include "readline/readline.h"
75 #include "readline/history.h"
76
77 /* readline defines this. */
78 #undef savestring
79
80 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
81 #include "extension.h"
82
83 /* Enums for exception-handling support. */
84 enum exception_event_kind
85 {
86 EX_EVENT_THROW,
87 EX_EVENT_RETHROW,
88 EX_EVENT_CATCH
89 };
90
91 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
92
93 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
94
95 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
96
97 static void enable_count_command (char *, int);
98
99 static void disable_command (char *, int);
100
101 static void enable_command (char *, int);
102
103 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*) (struct breakpoint *,
104 void *),
105 void *);
106
107 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
108
109 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
110
111 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
112
113 static void
114 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
115 struct linespec_result *canonical,
116 enum bptype type_wanted);
117
118 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
119 struct linespec_result *,
120 char *, char *, enum bptype,
121 enum bpdisp, int, int,
122 int,
123 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
124 int, int, int, unsigned);
125
126 static void decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
127 const struct event_location *location,
128 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals);
129
130 static void clear_command (char *, int);
131
132 static void catch_command (char *, int);
133
134 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
135
136 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
137
138 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
139
140 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
141 enum bptype,
142 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
143 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
144 const struct symtab_and_line *);
145
146 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
147 static. */
148 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
149 struct symtab_and_line,
150 enum bptype,
151 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
152
153 static struct breakpoint *
154 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
155 enum bptype type,
156 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
157 int loc_enabled);
158
159 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
160
161 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
162 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
163 enum bptype bptype);
164
165 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
166 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
167 struct obj_section *, int);
168
169 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
170 struct bp_location *loc2);
171
172 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
173 struct address_space *aspace,
174 CORE_ADDR addr);
175
176 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
177
178 static void watchpoints_info (char *, int);
179
180 static int breakpoint_1 (char *, int,
181 int (*) (const struct breakpoint *));
182
183 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
184
185 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
186
187 static void commands_command (char *, int);
188
189 static void condition_command (char *, int);
190
191 typedef enum
192 {
193 mark_inserted,
194 mark_uninserted
195 }
196 insertion_state_t;
197
198 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
199 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
200
201 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
202
203 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
204
205 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
206
207 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
208
209 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
210
211 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
212 enum bptype type,
213 int *other_type_used);
214
215 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
216
217 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
218
219 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
220 int count);
221
222 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
223
224 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
225
226 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
227
228 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
229
230 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
231 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
232 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
233
234 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
235
236 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
237 insert locations now. */
238 enum ugll_insert_mode
239 {
240 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
241 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
242 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
243 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
244 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
245 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
246 returns true on them.
247
248 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
249 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
250 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
251 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
252 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
253 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
254 the inferior. */
255 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
256
257 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
258 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
259 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
260
261 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
262 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
263 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
264 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
265 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
266 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
267 as no thread is running yet. */
268 UGLL_INSERT
269 };
270
271 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
272
273 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
274
275 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
276
277 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
278
279 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
280
281 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
282
283 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
284
285 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
286
287 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
288
289 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
290
291 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
292
293 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
294
295 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
296 otherwise. */
297
298 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
299
300 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
301 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
302 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
303 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
304
305 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
306 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
307
308 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
309 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
310
311 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception class type. */
312 static struct breakpoint_ops longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
313
314 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
315 breakpoints. */
316 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
317
318 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
319 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
320
321 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
322 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
323
324 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
325 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
326 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
327 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
328 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
329 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
330
331 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
332 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
333 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
334 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
335 dprintf_style_gdb,
336 dprintf_style_call,
337 dprintf_style_agent,
338 NULL
339 };
340 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
341
342 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
343 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
344 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
345 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
346
347 static char *dprintf_function = "";
348
349 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
350 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
351 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
352 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
353 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
354 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
355 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
356
357 static char *dprintf_channel = "";
358
359 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
360 has disconnected. */
361 static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
362
363 /* A reference-counted struct command_line. This lets multiple
364 breakpoints share a single command list. */
365 struct counted_command_line
366 {
367 /* The reference count. */
368 int refc;
369
370 /* The command list. */
371 struct command_line *commands;
372 };
373
374 struct command_line *
375 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
376 {
377 return b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
378 }
379
380 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
381 current breakpoint. */
382
383 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
384
385 const char *
386 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
387 {
388 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
389 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
390 a breakpoint. */
391 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
392
393 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
394 }
395
396 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
397 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
398 if such is available. */
399 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
400
401 static void
402 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
403 struct cmd_list_element *c,
404 const char *value)
405 {
406 fprintf_filtered (file,
407 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
408 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
409 value);
410 }
411
412 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
413 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
414 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
415 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
416 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
417 static void
418 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
419 struct cmd_list_element *c,
420 const char *value)
421 {
422 fprintf_filtered (file,
423 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
424 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
425 value);
426 }
427
428 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
429 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
430 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
431 use hardware breakpoints. */
432 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
433 static void
434 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
435 struct cmd_list_element *c,
436 const char *value)
437 {
438 fprintf_filtered (file,
439 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
440 value);
441 }
442
443 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
444 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
445 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
446 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
447 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
448 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
449 processing user input. */
450 static int always_inserted_mode = 0;
451
452 static void
453 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
454 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
455 {
456 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
457 value);
458 }
459
460 /* See breakpoint.h. */
461
462 int
463 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
464 {
465 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
466 {
467 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
468 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
469 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
470 return 1;
471 }
472 else if (target_has_execution)
473 {
474 struct thread_info *tp;
475
476 if (always_inserted_mode)
477 {
478 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
479 are stopped. */
480 return 1;
481 }
482
483 if (threads_are_executing ())
484 return 1;
485
486 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
487 stopped, we still have events to process. */
488 ALL_NON_EXITED_THREADS (tp)
489 if (tp->resumed
490 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
491 return 1;
492 }
493 return 0;
494 }
495
496 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
497
498 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
499 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
500 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
501 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
502 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
503 condition_evaluation_auto,
504 condition_evaluation_host,
505 condition_evaluation_target,
506 NULL
507 };
508
509 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
510 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
511
512 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
513 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
514 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
515
516 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
517 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
518 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
519 evaluation mode. */
520
521 static const char *
522 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
523 {
524 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
525 {
526 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
527 return condition_evaluation_target;
528 else
529 return condition_evaluation_host;
530 }
531 else
532 return mode;
533 }
534
535 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
536
537 static const char *
538 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
539 {
540 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
541 }
542
543 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
544 otherwise. */
545
546 static int
547 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
548 {
549 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
550
551 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
552 }
553
554 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
555
556 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
557 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
558
559 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
560 static int overlay_events_enabled;
561
562 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
563 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
564
565 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
566 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
567 current breakpoint. */
568
569 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
570
571 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
572 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
573 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
574 B = TMP)
575
576 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
577 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
578 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
579
580 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
581 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
582 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
583 BP_TMP++)
584
585 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
586 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
587 to where the loop should start from.
588 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
589 appropriate location to start with. */
590
591 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
592 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
593 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
594 BP_LOCP_START \
595 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count \
596 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
597 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
598
599 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
600
601 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
602 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
603 if (is_tracepoint (B))
604
605 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
606
607 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
608
609 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
610
611 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
612
613 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
614
615 static unsigned bp_location_count;
616
617 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
618 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid
619 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
620 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for
621 an address you need to read. */
622
623 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
624
625 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
626 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
627 BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
628 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to
629 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
630
631 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
632
633 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
634 from bp_location array, but for which a hit may still be reported
635 by a target. */
636 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
637
638 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
639
640 static int breakpoint_count;
641
642 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
643 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
644 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
645 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
646 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
647
648 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
649
650 static int tracepoint_count;
651
652 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
653 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
654 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
655
656 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
657
658 struct breakpoint *
659 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
660 void *user_data)
661 {
662 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
663
664 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
665 {
666 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
667 break;
668 }
669
670 return b;
671 }
672
673 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
674 static int
675 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
676 {
677 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
678 }
679
680 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
681
682 static void
683 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
684 {
685 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
686 breakpoint_count = num;
687 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
688 }
689
690 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
691 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
692 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
693
694 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
695 breakpoint made. */
696
697 void
698 start_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
699 {
700 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
701 }
702
703 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
704 breakpoint made. */
705
706 void
707 end_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
708 {
709 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
710 }
711
712 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
713
714 void
715 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
716 {
717 struct breakpoint *b;
718
719 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
720 b->hit_count = 0;
721 }
722
723 /* Allocate a new counted_command_line with reference count of 1.
724 The new structure owns COMMANDS. */
725
726 static struct counted_command_line *
727 alloc_counted_command_line (struct command_line *commands)
728 {
729 struct counted_command_line *result = XNEW (struct counted_command_line);
730
731 result->refc = 1;
732 result->commands = commands;
733
734 return result;
735 }
736
737 /* Increment reference count. This does nothing if CMD is NULL. */
738
739 static void
740 incref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line *cmd)
741 {
742 if (cmd)
743 ++cmd->refc;
744 }
745
746 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
747 destroy the counted_command_line. Sets *CMDP to NULL. This does
748 nothing if *CMDP is NULL. */
749
750 static void
751 decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
752 {
753 if (*cmdp)
754 {
755 if (--(*cmdp)->refc == 0)
756 {
757 free_command_lines (&(*cmdp)->commands);
758 xfree (*cmdp);
759 }
760 *cmdp = NULL;
761 }
762 }
763
764 /* A cleanup function that calls decref_counted_command_line. */
765
766 static void
767 do_cleanup_counted_command_line (void *arg)
768 {
769 decref_counted_command_line ((struct counted_command_line **) arg);
770 }
771
772 /* Create a cleanup that calls decref_counted_command_line on the
773 argument. */
774
775 static struct cleanup *
776 make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
777 {
778 return make_cleanup (do_cleanup_counted_command_line, cmdp);
779 }
780
781 \f
782 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
783 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
784
785 struct breakpoint *
786 get_breakpoint (int num)
787 {
788 struct breakpoint *b;
789
790 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
791 if (b->number == num)
792 return b;
793
794 return NULL;
795 }
796
797 \f
798
799 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
800 evaluating conditions on its side. */
801
802 static void
803 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
804 {
805 struct bp_location *loc;
806
807 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
808 evaluating conditions and if the user has
809 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
810 side. */
811 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
812 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
813 return;
814
815 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
816 return;
817
818 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
819 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
820 }
821
822 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
823 evaluating conditions on its side. */
824
825 static void
826 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
827 {
828 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
829 evaluating conditions and if the user has
830 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
831 side. */
832 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
833 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
834
835 return;
836
837 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
838 return;
839
840 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
841 }
842
843 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
844 condition_evaluation_mode. */
845
846 static void
847 set_condition_evaluation_mode (char *args, int from_tty,
848 struct cmd_list_element *c)
849 {
850 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
851
852 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
853 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
854 {
855 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
856 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
857 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
858 return;
859 }
860
861 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
862 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
863
864 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
865 settings was "auto". */
866 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
867
868 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
869 if (new_mode != old_mode)
870 {
871 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
872 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
873 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
874
875 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
876 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
877 */
878
879 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
880 {
881 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
882 target. */
883 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
884 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
885 }
886 else
887 {
888 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
889 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
890 target knows about. */
891 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
892 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
893 loc->needs_update = 1;
894 }
895
896 /* Do the update. */
897 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
898 }
899
900 return;
901 }
902
903 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
904 what "auto" is translating to. */
905
906 static void
907 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
908 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
909 {
910 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
911 fprintf_filtered (file,
912 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
913 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
914 value,
915 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
916 else
917 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
918 value);
919 }
920
921 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
922 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
923 the more general bp_location_compare function. */
924
925 static int
926 bp_location_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
927 {
928 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
929 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
930
931 if (a->address == b->address)
932 return 0;
933 else
934 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
935 }
936
937 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
938 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
939 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
940 return NULL. */
941
942 static struct bp_location **
943 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
944 {
945 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
946 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
947 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
948
949 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
950 memset (&dummy_loc, 0, sizeof (struct bp_location));
951 dummy_loc.address = address;
952
953 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
954 locp_found = ((struct bp_location **)
955 bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_location, bp_location_count,
956 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
957 bp_location_compare_addrs));
958
959 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
960 if (locp_found == NULL)
961 return NULL;
962
963 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
964 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
965 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_location
966 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
967 locp_found--;
968
969 return locp_found;
970 }
971
972 void
973 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
974 int from_tty)
975 {
976 xfree (b->cond_string);
977 b->cond_string = NULL;
978
979 if (is_watchpoint (b))
980 {
981 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
982
983 xfree (w->cond_exp);
984 w->cond_exp = NULL;
985 }
986 else
987 {
988 struct bp_location *loc;
989
990 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
991 {
992 xfree (loc->cond);
993 loc->cond = NULL;
994
995 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
996 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
997 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
998 }
999 }
1000
1001 if (*exp == 0)
1002 {
1003 if (from_tty)
1004 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
1005 }
1006 else
1007 {
1008 const char *arg = exp;
1009
1010 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
1011 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
1012 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
1013 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
1014
1015 if (is_watchpoint (b))
1016 {
1017 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
1018
1019 innermost_block = NULL;
1020 arg = exp;
1021 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
1022 if (*arg)
1023 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
1024 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
1025 }
1026 else
1027 {
1028 struct bp_location *loc;
1029
1030 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1031 {
1032 arg = exp;
1033 loc->cond =
1034 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
1035 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
1036 if (*arg)
1037 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
1038 }
1039 }
1040 }
1041 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
1042
1043 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1044 }
1045
1046 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
1047
1048 static VEC (char_ptr) *
1049 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
1050 const char *text, const char *word)
1051 {
1052 const char *space;
1053
1054 text = skip_spaces_const (text);
1055 space = skip_to_space_const (text);
1056 if (*space == '\0')
1057 {
1058 int len;
1059 struct breakpoint *b;
1060 VEC (char_ptr) *result = NULL;
1061
1062 if (text[0] == '$')
1063 {
1064 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
1065 if (isdigit (text[1]))
1066 return NULL;
1067 return complete_internalvar (&text[1]);
1068 }
1069
1070 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
1071 len = strlen (text);
1072
1073 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1074 {
1075 char number[50];
1076
1077 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
1078
1079 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
1080 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, result, xstrdup (number));
1081 }
1082
1083 return result;
1084 }
1085
1086 /* We're completing the expression part. */
1087 text = skip_spaces_const (space);
1088 return expression_completer (cmd, text, word);
1089 }
1090
1091 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
1092
1093 static void
1094 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1095 {
1096 struct breakpoint *b;
1097 char *p;
1098 int bnum;
1099
1100 if (arg == 0)
1101 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
1102
1103 p = arg;
1104 bnum = get_number (&p);
1105 if (bnum == 0)
1106 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
1107
1108 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1109 if (b->number == bnum)
1110 {
1111 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
1112 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
1113 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
1114 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
1115 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
1116
1117 if (extlang != NULL)
1118 {
1119 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
1120 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
1121 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
1122 }
1123 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
1124
1125 if (is_breakpoint (b))
1126 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
1127
1128 return;
1129 }
1130
1131 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
1132 }
1133
1134 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1135 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1136 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1137
1138 static void
1139 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1140 {
1141 struct command_line *c;
1142
1143 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1144 {
1145 int i;
1146
1147 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1148 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1149 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1150
1151 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
1152 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
1153
1154 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1155 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1156 command directly. */
1157 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1158 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1159
1160 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1161 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1162 }
1163 }
1164
1165 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1166
1167 static int
1168 is_tracepoint_type (enum bptype type)
1169 {
1170 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1171 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1172 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1173 }
1174
1175 int
1176 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1177 {
1178 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1179 }
1180
1181 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1182 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1183 found. */
1184
1185 static void
1186 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1187 struct command_line *commands)
1188 {
1189 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1190 {
1191 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1192 struct command_line *c;
1193 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1194
1195 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1196 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1197 ones might not. */
1198 t->step_count = 0;
1199
1200 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1201 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1202 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1203 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1204 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1205 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1206 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1207 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1208 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1209 tracepoint's context. */
1210 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1211 {
1212 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1213 {
1214 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1215 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1216 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1217 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1218 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1219 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1220
1221 if (while_stepping)
1222 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1223 "can be used only once"));
1224 else
1225 while_stepping = c;
1226 }
1227
1228 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1229 }
1230 if (while_stepping)
1231 {
1232 struct command_line *c2;
1233
1234 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
1235 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
1236 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1237 {
1238 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1239 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1240 }
1241 }
1242 }
1243 else
1244 {
1245 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1246 }
1247 }
1248
1249 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1250 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1251
1252 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
1253 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1254 {
1255 struct breakpoint *b;
1256 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
1257 struct bp_location *loc;
1258
1259 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1260 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1261 {
1262 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1263 if (loc->address == addr)
1264 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
1265 }
1266
1267 return found;
1268 }
1269
1270 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1271 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1272
1273 void
1274 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1275 struct command_line *commands)
1276 {
1277 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands);
1278
1279 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1280 b->commands = alloc_counted_command_line (commands);
1281 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1282 }
1283
1284 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1285 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1286 commands. */
1287
1288 void
1289 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1290 {
1291 int old_silent = b->silent;
1292
1293 b->silent = silent;
1294 if (old_silent != silent)
1295 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1296 }
1297
1298 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1299 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1300
1301 void
1302 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1303 {
1304 int old_thread = b->thread;
1305
1306 b->thread = thread;
1307 if (old_thread != thread)
1308 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1309 }
1310
1311 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1312 breakpoint work for any task. */
1313
1314 void
1315 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1316 {
1317 int old_task = b->task;
1318
1319 b->task = task;
1320 if (old_task != task)
1321 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1322 }
1323
1324 void
1325 check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
1326 {
1327 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) closure;
1328
1329 validate_actionline (line, b);
1330 }
1331
1332 /* A structure used to pass information through
1333 map_breakpoint_numbers. */
1334
1335 struct commands_info
1336 {
1337 /* True if the command was typed at a tty. */
1338 int from_tty;
1339
1340 /* The breakpoint range spec. */
1341 char *arg;
1342
1343 /* Non-NULL if the body of the commands are being read from this
1344 already-parsed command. */
1345 struct command_line *control;
1346
1347 /* The command lines read from the user, or NULL if they have not
1348 yet been read. */
1349 struct counted_command_line *cmd;
1350 };
1351
1352 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that sets the commands for
1353 commands_command. */
1354
1355 static void
1356 do_map_commands_command (struct breakpoint *b, void *data)
1357 {
1358 struct commands_info *info = (struct commands_info *) data;
1359
1360 if (info->cmd == NULL)
1361 {
1362 struct command_line *l;
1363
1364 if (info->control != NULL)
1365 l = copy_command_lines (info->control->body_list[0]);
1366 else
1367 {
1368 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1369 char *str;
1370
1371 str = xstrprintf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1372 "%s, one per line."),
1373 info->arg);
1374
1375 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
1376
1377 l = read_command_lines (str,
1378 info->from_tty, 1,
1379 (is_tracepoint (b)
1380 ? check_tracepoint_command : 0),
1381 b);
1382
1383 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1384 }
1385
1386 info->cmd = alloc_counted_command_line (l);
1387 }
1388
1389 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1390 do anything. */
1391 if (b->commands != info->cmd)
1392 {
1393 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, info->cmd->commands);
1394 incref_counted_command_line (info->cmd);
1395 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1396 b->commands = info->cmd;
1397 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1398 }
1399 }
1400
1401 static void
1402 commands_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
1403 struct command_line *control)
1404 {
1405 struct cleanup *cleanups;
1406 struct commands_info info;
1407
1408 info.from_tty = from_tty;
1409 info.control = control;
1410 info.cmd = NULL;
1411 /* If we read command lines from the user, then `info' will hold an
1412 extra reference to the commands that we must clean up. */
1413 cleanups = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&info.cmd);
1414
1415 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1416 {
1417 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1418 arg = xstrprintf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1419 breakpoint_count);
1420 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1421 arg = xstrprintf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1422 else
1423 {
1424 /* So that we don't try to free the incoming non-NULL
1425 argument in the cleanup below. Mapping breakpoint
1426 numbers will fail in this case. */
1427 arg = NULL;
1428 }
1429 }
1430 else
1431 /* The command loop has some static state, so we need to preserve
1432 our argument. */
1433 arg = xstrdup (arg);
1434
1435 if (arg != NULL)
1436 make_cleanup (xfree, arg);
1437
1438 info.arg = arg;
1439
1440 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_commands_command, &info);
1441
1442 if (info.cmd == NULL)
1443 error (_("No breakpoints specified."));
1444
1445 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1446 }
1447
1448 static void
1449 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1450 {
1451 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1452 }
1453
1454 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1455 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1456
1457 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1458 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1459 enum command_control_type
1460 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1461 {
1462 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1463 return simple_control;
1464 }
1465
1466 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1467
1468 static int
1469 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1470 {
1471 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1472 return 0;
1473 if (!bl->inserted)
1474 return 0;
1475 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1476 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1477 return 0;
1478 return 1;
1479 }
1480
1481 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1482 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1483 contents.
1484
1485 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1486 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1487 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1488
1489 static void
1490 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1491 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1492 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1493 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1494 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1495 {
1496 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1497 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1498 int bp_size = 0;
1499 int bptoffset = 0;
1500
1501 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1502 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1503 {
1504 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1505 return;
1506 }
1507
1508 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1509 we need to copy. */
1510 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1511 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1512
1513 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1514 {
1515 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1516 reading. */
1517 return;
1518 }
1519
1520 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1521 {
1522 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1523 reading. */
1524 return;
1525 }
1526
1527 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1528 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1529 {
1530 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1531 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1532 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1533 bp_addr = memaddr;
1534 }
1535
1536 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1537 {
1538 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1539 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1540 }
1541
1542 if (readbuf != NULL)
1543 {
1544 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1545 shadow_contents buffer. */
1546 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1547 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1548 + target_info->shadow_len));
1549
1550 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1551 shadow. */
1552 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1553 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1554 }
1555 else
1556 {
1557 const unsigned char *bp;
1558 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1559 int placed_size;
1560
1561 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1562 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1563 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1564
1565 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1566 address. */
1567 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1568
1569 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1570 breakpoint's INSN. */
1571 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1572 }
1573 }
1574
1575 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1576 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1577
1578 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1579 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1580 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1581
1582 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1583 bl->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1584 up to bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1585 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1586 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1587 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1588 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1589 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
1590 and:
1591 bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1592
1593 void
1594 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1595 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1596 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1597 {
1598 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1599 search. */
1600 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1601 size_t i;
1602
1603 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1604 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1605 report higher one. */
1606
1607 bc_l = 0;
1608 bc_r = bp_location_count;
1609 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1610 {
1611 struct bp_location *bl;
1612
1613 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1614 bl = bp_location[bc];
1615
1616 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1617 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1618 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1619 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1620
1621 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1622 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1623 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1624
1625 if ((bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1626 >= bl->address)
1627 && (bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1628 <= memaddr))
1629 bc_l = bc;
1630 else
1631 bc_r = bc;
1632 }
1633
1634 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1635 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1636 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1637 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1638 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1639 B:
1640
1641 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1642
1643 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1644 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1645 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1646 and L2. */
1647 while (bc_l > 0
1648 && bp_location[bc_l]->address == bp_location[bc_l - 1]->address)
1649 bc_l--;
1650
1651 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1652
1653 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
1654 {
1655 struct bp_location *bl = bp_location[bc];
1656 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1657 int bp_size = 0;
1658 int bptoffset = 0;
1659
1660 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1661 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1662 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1663 bl->owner->number);
1664
1665 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1666 content. */
1667
1668 if (bl->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1669 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1670 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max))
1671 break;
1672
1673 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1674 continue;
1675
1676 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1677 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1678 }
1679 }
1680
1681 \f
1682
1683 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1684 breakpoint. */
1685
1686 int
1687 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1688 {
1689 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1690 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1691 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1692 }
1693
1694 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1695
1696 static int
1697 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1698 {
1699 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1700 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1701 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1702 }
1703
1704 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1705 software. */
1706
1707 int
1708 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1709 {
1710 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1711 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1712 }
1713
1714 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1715 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1716 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1717 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1718 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1719 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1720 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1721 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1722
1723 static int
1724 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1725 {
1726 return (b->base.pspace == current_program_space
1727 && (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1728 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1729 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))));
1730 }
1731
1732 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1733 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1734
1735 static void
1736 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1737 {
1738 struct breakpoint *b = &w->base;
1739
1740 if (b->related_breakpoint != b)
1741 {
1742 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1743 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == b);
1744 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1745 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
1746 b->related_breakpoint = b;
1747 }
1748 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1749 }
1750
1751 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1752 watchpoint W. */
1753
1754 static struct value *
1755 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1756 {
1757 struct value *bit_val;
1758
1759 if (val == NULL)
1760 return NULL;
1761
1762 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1763
1764 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1765 w->val_bitpos,
1766 w->val_bitsize,
1767 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1768 value_offset (val),
1769 val);
1770
1771 return bit_val;
1772 }
1773
1774 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1775 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1776 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1777 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1778 in b->loc->cond.
1779 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1780
1781 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1782 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1783 it.
1784
1785 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1786 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1787 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1788 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1789 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1790 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1791 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1792 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1793
1794 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1795 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1796 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1797 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1798 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1799 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1800 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1801 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1802 not changed.
1803
1804 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1805 hardware watchpoints:
1806
1807 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1808 called several times when GDB stops.
1809
1810 [linux]
1811 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1812 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1813 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1814 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1815 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1816 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1817 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1818 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1819 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1820 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1821 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1822
1823 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1824 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1825
1826 static void
1827 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1828 {
1829 int within_current_scope;
1830 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1831 int frame_saved;
1832
1833 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1834 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1835 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1836 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1837 return;
1838
1839 if (b->base.disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1840 return;
1841
1842 frame_saved = 0;
1843
1844 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1845 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1846 within_current_scope = 1;
1847 else
1848 {
1849 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1850 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1851 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1852
1853 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1854 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1855 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1856 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1857 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1858 return;
1859
1860 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1861 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1862 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1863 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1864 selected frame. */
1865 frame_saved = 1;
1866 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1867
1868 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1869 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1870 if (within_current_scope)
1871 select_frame (fi);
1872 }
1873
1874 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1875 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1876 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1877 b->base.loc = NULL;
1878
1879 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1880 {
1881 const char *s;
1882
1883 if (b->exp)
1884 {
1885 xfree (b->exp);
1886 b->exp = NULL;
1887 }
1888 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1889 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1890 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1891 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1892 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1893 be completely different objects. */
1894 value_free (b->val);
1895 b->val = NULL;
1896 b->val_valid = 0;
1897
1898 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1899 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1900 locations (re)created below. */
1901 if (b->base.cond_string != NULL)
1902 {
1903 if (b->cond_exp != NULL)
1904 {
1905 xfree (b->cond_exp);
1906 b->cond_exp = NULL;
1907 }
1908
1909 s = b->base.cond_string;
1910 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1911 }
1912 }
1913
1914 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1915 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1916 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1917 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1918 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1919 if (!target_has_execution)
1920 {
1921 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1922 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1923 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1924 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1925 {
1926 if (b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
1927 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
1928 else
1929 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1930 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1931 }
1932 }
1933 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1934 {
1935 int pc = 0;
1936 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1937 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1938
1939 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1940
1941 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1942 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1943 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1944 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1945 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1946 watchpoints. */
1947 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
1948 {
1949 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1950 {
1951 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1952 if (v != NULL)
1953 release_value (v);
1954 }
1955 b->val = v;
1956 b->val_valid = 1;
1957 }
1958
1959 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1960
1961 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1962 for (v = val_chain; v; v = value_next (v))
1963 {
1964 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1965 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1966 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1967 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1968 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1969 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1970 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1971 {
1972 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1973
1974 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1975 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1976 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1977 if (v == result
1978 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1979 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1980 {
1981 CORE_ADDR addr;
1982 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1983 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1984 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1985
1986 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1987 {
1988 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1989 sub-expression. */
1990 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1991 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1992 }
1993 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1994 {
1995 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1996 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1997 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1998 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1999 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
2000 }
2001
2002 addr = value_address (v);
2003 if (bitsize != 0)
2004 {
2005 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
2006 addr += bitpos / 8;
2007 }
2008
2009 type = hw_write;
2010 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
2011 type = hw_read;
2012 else if (b->base.type == bp_access_watchpoint)
2013 type = hw_access;
2014
2015 loc = allocate_bp_location (&b->base);
2016 for (tmp = &(b->base.loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
2017 ;
2018 *tmp = loc;
2019 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
2020
2021 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
2022 loc->address = addr;
2023
2024 if (bitsize != 0)
2025 {
2026 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
2027 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
2028 }
2029 else
2030 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
2031
2032 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
2033 }
2034 }
2035 }
2036
2037 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
2038 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
2039 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
2040 is started. */
2041 if (reparse)
2042 {
2043 int reg_cnt;
2044 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
2045 struct bp_location *bl;
2046
2047 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
2048
2049 if (reg_cnt)
2050 {
2051 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
2052 enum bptype type;
2053
2054 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
2055 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
2056 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
2057
2058 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
2059 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
2060 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
2061 this watchpoint in as well. */
2062
2063 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
2064 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
2065 hardware watchpoint type. */
2066 type = b->base.type;
2067 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
2068 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
2069
2070 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
2071 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
2072 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
2073 through watch_command), so always account for it
2074 manually. */
2075
2076 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
2077 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (&b->base, type, &other_type_used);
2078
2079 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
2080 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (&b->base);
2081
2082 target_resources_ok
2083 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
2084 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
2085 {
2086 int sw_mode = b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base);
2087
2088 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
2089 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
2090 "hardware watchpoint."));
2091 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
2092 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
2093 "resources for this watchpoint."));
2094
2095 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
2096 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
2097 }
2098 else
2099 {
2100 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
2101 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
2102 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
2103 nop. */
2104 b->base.type = type;
2105 }
2106 }
2107 else if (!b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
2108 {
2109 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
2110 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
2111 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
2112 else
2113 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
2114 "read/access watchpoint."));
2115 }
2116 else
2117 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
2118
2119 loc_type = (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
2120 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
2121 for (bl = b->base.loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
2122 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
2123 }
2124
2125 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
2126 {
2127 next = value_next (v);
2128 if (v != b->val)
2129 value_free (v);
2130 }
2131
2132 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
2133 above left it without any location set up. But,
2134 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
2135 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
2136 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint && b->base.loc == NULL)
2137 {
2138 struct breakpoint *base = &b->base;
2139 base->loc = allocate_bp_location (base);
2140 base->loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
2141 base->loc->address = -1;
2142 base->loc->length = -1;
2143 base->loc->watchpoint_type = -1;
2144 }
2145 }
2146 else if (!within_current_scope)
2147 {
2148 printf_filtered (_("\
2149 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
2150 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
2151 b->base.number);
2152 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
2153 }
2154
2155 /* Restore the selected frame. */
2156 if (frame_saved)
2157 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
2158 }
2159
2160
2161 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
2162 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
2163 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
2164 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
2165 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
2166 static int
2167 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2168 {
2169 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2170 return 0;
2171
2172 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2173 return 0;
2174
2175 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2176 return 0;
2177
2178 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2179 return 0;
2180
2181 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2182 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2183 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2184 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2185 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2186 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2187 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2188 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2189 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2190 return 0;
2191
2192 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2193 location. */
2194 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2195 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2196 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2197 bl->address))
2198 {
2199 if (debug_infrun)
2200 {
2201 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2202 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2203 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2204 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2205 }
2206 return 0;
2207 }
2208
2209 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2210 instruction that triggered one. */
2211 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2212 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2213 {
2214 if (debug_infrun)
2215 {
2216 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2217 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2218 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2219 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2220 bl->length);
2221 }
2222 return 0;
2223 }
2224
2225 return 1;
2226 }
2227
2228 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2229 that the location is not duplicated. */
2230
2231 static int
2232 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2233 {
2234 int result;
2235 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2236
2237 bl->duplicate = 0;
2238 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2239 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2240 return result;
2241 }
2242
2243 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2244 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2245 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2246 any error during parsing. */
2247
2248 static struct agent_expr *
2249 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2250 {
2251 struct agent_expr *aexpr = NULL;
2252
2253 if (!cond)
2254 return NULL;
2255
2256 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2257 that may show up. */
2258 TRY
2259 {
2260 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2261 }
2262
2263 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2264 {
2265 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2266 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2267 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2268 return NULL;
2269 }
2270 END_CATCH
2271
2272 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2273 return aexpr;
2274 }
2275
2276 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2277 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2278 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2279 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2280 one of them is true. */
2281
2282 static void
2283 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2284 {
2285 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2286 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2287 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2288 struct bp_location *loc;
2289
2290 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2291 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions);
2292
2293 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2294 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2295 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2296 side. */
2297 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2298 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2299 return;
2300
2301 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2302 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2303 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2304 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2305 response back to GDB. */
2306 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2307 {
2308 loc = (*loc2p);
2309 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2310 {
2311 if (modified)
2312 {
2313 struct agent_expr *aexpr;
2314
2315 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2316 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2317 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2318 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2319 aexpr = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address, loc->cond);
2320 loc->cond_bytecode = aexpr;
2321
2322 /* Check if we managed to parse the conditional expression
2323 correctly. If not, we will not send this condition
2324 to the target. */
2325 if (aexpr)
2326 continue;
2327 }
2328
2329 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2330 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2331 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2332 {
2333 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2334 break;
2335 }
2336 }
2337 }
2338
2339 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2340 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2341 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2342
2343 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2344 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2345 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2346 {
2347 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2348 {
2349 loc = (*loc2p);
2350 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2351 {
2352 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2353 located. */
2354 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2355 return;
2356
2357 free_agent_expr (loc->cond_bytecode);
2358 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
2359 }
2360 }
2361 }
2362
2363 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2364 for this location's address. */
2365 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2366 {
2367 loc = (*loc2p);
2368 if (loc->cond
2369 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2370 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2371 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2372 && loc->enabled)
2373 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later to send the
2374 conditions to the target. */
2375 VEC_safe_push (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions,
2376 loc->cond_bytecode);
2377 }
2378
2379 return;
2380 }
2381
2382 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2383 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2384 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2385
2386 static struct agent_expr *
2387 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2388 {
2389 struct cleanup *old_cleanups = 0;
2390 struct expression *expr, **argvec;
2391 struct agent_expr *aexpr = NULL;
2392 const char *cmdrest;
2393 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2394 struct format_piece *fpieces;
2395 int nargs;
2396 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2397
2398 if (!cmd)
2399 return NULL;
2400
2401 cmdrest = cmd;
2402
2403 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2404 ++cmdrest;
2405 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2406
2407 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2408 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2409
2410 format_start = cmdrest;
2411
2412 fpieces = parse_format_string (&cmdrest);
2413
2414 old_cleanups = make_cleanup (free_format_pieces_cleanup, &fpieces);
2415
2416 format_end = cmdrest;
2417
2418 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2419 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2420
2421 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2422
2423 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2424 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2425
2426 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2427 cmdrest++;
2428 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2429
2430 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2431
2432 argvec = (struct expression **) alloca (strlen (cmd)
2433 * sizeof (struct expression *));
2434
2435 nargs = 0;
2436 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2437 {
2438 const char *cmd1;
2439
2440 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2441 expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2442 argvec[nargs++] = expr;
2443 cmdrest = cmd1;
2444 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2445 ++cmdrest;
2446 }
2447
2448 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2449 that may show up. */
2450 TRY
2451 {
2452 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2453 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2454 fpieces, nargs, argvec);
2455 }
2456 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2457 {
2458 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2459 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2460 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2461 aexpr = NULL;
2462 }
2463 END_CATCH
2464
2465 do_cleanups (old_cleanups);
2466
2467 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2468 return aexpr;
2469 }
2470
2471 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2472 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2473 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2474
2475 static void
2476 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2477 {
2478 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2479 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2480 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2481 struct bp_location *loc;
2482
2483 /* Release commands left over from a previous insert. */
2484 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.tcommands);
2485
2486 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2487 return;
2488
2489 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2490 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2491 return;
2492
2493 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2494 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2495 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2496 control. */
2497 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2498 {
2499 loc = (*loc2p);
2500 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2501 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2502 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2503 return;
2504 }
2505
2506 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2507 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2508 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2509 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2510 response back to GDB. */
2511 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2512 {
2513 loc = (*loc2p);
2514 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2515 {
2516 if (modified)
2517 {
2518 struct agent_expr *aexpr;
2519
2520 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2521 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2522 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2523 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2524 aexpr = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2525 loc->owner->extra_string);
2526 loc->cmd_bytecode = aexpr;
2527
2528 if (!aexpr)
2529 continue;
2530 }
2531
2532 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2533 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2534 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2535 {
2536 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2537 break;
2538 }
2539 }
2540 }
2541
2542 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2543 and so clean up. */
2544 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2545 {
2546 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2547 {
2548 loc = (*loc2p);
2549 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2550 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2551 {
2552 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2553 located. */
2554 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2555 return;
2556
2557 free_agent_expr (loc->cmd_bytecode);
2558 loc->cmd_bytecode = NULL;
2559 }
2560 }
2561 }
2562
2563 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2564 for this location's address. */
2565 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2566 {
2567 loc = (*loc2p);
2568 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2569 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2570 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2571 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2572 && loc->enabled)
2573 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2574 to send the commands to the target. */
2575 VEC_safe_push (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.tcommands,
2576 loc->cmd_bytecode);
2577 }
2578
2579 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2580 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2581 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2582 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2583 }
2584
2585 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2586 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2587 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2588 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2589 -1 for failure.
2590
2591 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2592 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2593 static int
2594 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2595 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2596 int *disabled_breaks,
2597 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2598 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2599 {
2600 enum errors bp_err = GDB_NO_ERROR;
2601 const char *bp_err_message = NULL;
2602
2603 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2604 return 0;
2605
2606 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2607 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2608 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2609 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2610 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2611 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2612 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2613 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2614 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2615 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2616 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2617 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2618
2619 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2620 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2621 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2622 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2623
2624 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2625 {
2626 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2627 build_target_command_list (bl);
2628 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2629 bl->needs_update = 0;
2630 }
2631
2632 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2633 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2634 {
2635 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2636 {
2637 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2638 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2639 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2640
2641 Two important cases are:
2642 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2643 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2644 hardware breakpoint.
2645 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2646 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2647 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2648 so we undo.
2649
2650 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2651 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2652 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2653 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2654 gdb. */
2655 struct mem_region *mr
2656 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2657
2658 if (mr)
2659 {
2660 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2661 {
2662 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2663
2664 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2665 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2666 else
2667 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2668
2669 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2670 {
2671 static int said = 0;
2672
2673 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2674 if (!said)
2675 {
2676 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2677 _("Note: automatically using "
2678 "hardware breakpoints for "
2679 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2680 said = 1;
2681 }
2682 }
2683 }
2684 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2685 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2686 {
2687 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2688 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2689 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2690 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2691 bl->owner->number,
2692 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2693 return 1;
2694 }
2695 }
2696 }
2697
2698 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2699 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2700 || bl->section == NULL
2701 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2702 {
2703 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2704 TRY
2705 {
2706 int val;
2707
2708 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2709 if (val)
2710 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2711 }
2712 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2713 {
2714 bp_err = e.error;
2715 bp_err_message = e.message;
2716 }
2717 END_CATCH
2718 }
2719 else
2720 {
2721 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2722 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2723 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2724 {
2725 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2726 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2727 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2728 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2729 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2730 bl->owner->number);
2731 else
2732 {
2733 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2734 bl->section);
2735 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2736 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2737 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2738
2739 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2740 TRY
2741 {
2742 int val;
2743
2744 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2745 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2746 if (val)
2747 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2748 }
2749 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2750 {
2751 bp_err = e.error;
2752 bp_err_message = e.message;
2753 }
2754 END_CATCH
2755
2756 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2757 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2758 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2759 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2760 bl->owner->number);
2761 }
2762 }
2763 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2764 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2765 {
2766 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2767 TRY
2768 {
2769 int val;
2770
2771 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2772 if (val)
2773 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2774 }
2775 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2776 {
2777 bp_err = e.error;
2778 bp_err_message = e.message;
2779 }
2780 END_CATCH
2781 }
2782 else
2783 {
2784 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2785 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2786 return 0;
2787 }
2788 }
2789
2790 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2791 {
2792 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2793
2794 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2795 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2796 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2797 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2798 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2799 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2800 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2801 errors as memory errors. */
2802 if ((bp_err == GENERIC_ERROR || bp_err == MEMORY_ERROR)
2803 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2804 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2805 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2806 bl->address)))
2807 {
2808 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2809 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2810 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bl->owner);
2811 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2812 {
2813 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2814 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2815 bl->owner->number);
2816 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2817 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2818 "library breakpoints:\n");
2819 }
2820 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2821 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2822 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2823 return 0;
2824 }
2825 else
2826 {
2827 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2828 {
2829 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2830 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_err_message != NULL;
2831 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2832 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2833 bl->owner->number, bp_err_message ? ":" : ".\n");
2834 if (bp_err_message != NULL)
2835 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n", bp_err_message);
2836 }
2837 else
2838 {
2839 if (bp_err_message == NULL)
2840 {
2841 char *message
2842 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2843 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2844 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
2845
2846 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2847 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2848 "%s\n",
2849 bl->owner->number, message);
2850 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2851 }
2852 else
2853 {
2854 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2855 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2856 bl->owner->number,
2857 bp_err_message);
2858 }
2859 }
2860 return 1;
2861
2862 }
2863 }
2864 else
2865 bl->inserted = 1;
2866
2867 return 0;
2868 }
2869
2870 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2871 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2872 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2873 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2874 {
2875 int val;
2876
2877 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2878 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2879
2880 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2881
2882 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2883 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2884 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2885 {
2886 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2887
2888 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2889 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2890 of this one. */
2891 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2892 if (loc != bl
2893 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2894 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2895 {
2896 bl->duplicate = 1;
2897 bl->inserted = 1;
2898 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2899 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2900 val = 0;
2901 break;
2902 }
2903
2904 if (val == 1)
2905 {
2906 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2907 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2908
2909 if (val)
2910 /* Back to the original value. */
2911 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2912 }
2913 }
2914
2915 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2916 }
2917
2918 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2919 {
2920 int val;
2921
2922 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2923 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2924
2925 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2926 if (val)
2927 {
2928 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2929
2930 if (val == 1)
2931 warning (_("\
2932 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2933 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2934 else
2935 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2936 }
2937
2938 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2939
2940 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2941 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2942 so just return success. */
2943 return 0;
2944 }
2945
2946 return 0;
2947 }
2948
2949 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2950 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2951 PSPACE anymore. */
2952
2953 void
2954 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2955 {
2956 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2957 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2958
2959 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2960 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2961 {
2962 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2963 delete_breakpoint (b);
2964 }
2965
2966 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2967 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2968 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2969 {
2970 struct bp_location *tmp;
2971
2972 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2973 {
2974 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2975 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2976 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2977 else
2978 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2979 if (tmp->next == loc)
2980 {
2981 tmp->next = loc->next;
2982 break;
2983 }
2984 }
2985 }
2986
2987 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2988 removed locations above. */
2989 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2990 }
2991
2992 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2993 Throws exception on any error.
2994 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2995 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2996 void
2997 insert_breakpoints (void)
2998 {
2999 struct breakpoint *bpt;
3000
3001 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
3002 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3003 {
3004 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
3005
3006 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3007 }
3008
3009 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
3010 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
3011 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
3012 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
3013 }
3014
3015 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
3016
3017 void
3018 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
3019 {
3020 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
3021
3022 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
3023 {
3024 callback (loc, NULL);
3025 }
3026 }
3027
3028 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
3029 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
3030 always-inserted mode. */
3031
3032 static void
3033 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
3034 {
3035 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3036 int error_flag = 0;
3037 int val = 0;
3038 int disabled_breaks = 0;
3039 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
3040 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
3041
3042 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3043 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3044
3045 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
3046 there was an error. */
3047 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
3048
3049 save_current_space_and_thread ();
3050
3051 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3052 {
3053 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
3054 breakpoints. */
3055 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
3056 continue;
3057
3058 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
3059 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
3060 deletion of breakpoints. */
3061 if (!bl->inserted || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
3062 continue;
3063
3064 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3065
3066 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3067 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3068 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3069 insert breakpoints. */
3070 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3071 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3072 continue;
3073
3074 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3075 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
3076 if (val)
3077 error_flag = val;
3078 }
3079
3080 if (error_flag)
3081 {
3082 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
3083 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3084 }
3085
3086 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3087 }
3088
3089 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
3090
3091 static void
3092 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
3093 {
3094 struct breakpoint *bpt;
3095 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3096 int error_flag = 0;
3097 int val = 0;
3098 int disabled_breaks = 0;
3099 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
3100 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
3101
3102 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3103 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3104
3105 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
3106 there was an error. */
3107 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
3108
3109 save_current_space_and_thread ();
3110
3111 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3112 {
3113 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
3114 continue;
3115
3116 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
3117 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
3118 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3119 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
3120 && !valid_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
3121 continue;
3122
3123 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3124
3125 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3126 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3127 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3128 insert breakpoints. */
3129 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3130 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3131 continue;
3132
3133 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3134 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
3135 if (val)
3136 error_flag = val;
3137 }
3138
3139 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
3140 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
3141 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
3142 {
3143 int some_failed = 0;
3144 struct bp_location *loc;
3145
3146 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3147 continue;
3148
3149 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
3150 continue;
3151
3152 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
3153 continue;
3154
3155 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3156 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
3157 {
3158 some_failed = 1;
3159 break;
3160 }
3161 if (some_failed)
3162 {
3163 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3164 if (loc->inserted)
3165 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
3166
3167 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3168 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
3169 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3170 bpt->number);
3171 error_flag = -1;
3172 }
3173 }
3174
3175 if (error_flag)
3176 {
3177 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3178 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3179 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3180 {
3181 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
3182 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3183 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3184 }
3185 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
3186 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3187 }
3188
3189 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3190 }
3191
3192 /* Used when the program stops.
3193 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3194 removing a breakpoint location. */
3195
3196 int
3197 remove_breakpoints (void)
3198 {
3199 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3200 int val = 0;
3201
3202 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3203 {
3204 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3205 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
3206 }
3207 return val;
3208 }
3209
3210 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3211 that thread. */
3212
3213 static void
3214 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3215 {
3216 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3217
3218 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3219 {
3220 if (b->thread == tp->num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3221 {
3222 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3223
3224 printf_filtered (_("\
3225 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %d no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3226 b->number, tp->num);
3227
3228 /* Hide it from the user. */
3229 b->number = 0;
3230 }
3231 }
3232 }
3233
3234 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
3235
3236 int
3237 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
3238 {
3239 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3240 int val;
3241 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3242
3243 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3244 {
3245 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3246 continue;
3247
3248 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3249 {
3250 val = remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
3251 if (val != 0)
3252 return val;
3253 }
3254 }
3255 return 0;
3256 }
3257
3258 int
3259 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
3260 {
3261 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3262 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3263 int val;
3264 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream;
3265 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0, dummy3 = 0;
3266 struct inferior *inf;
3267 struct thread_info *tp;
3268
3269 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
3270 if (tp == NULL)
3271 return 1;
3272
3273 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3274 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3275
3276 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
3277
3278 tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3279 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3280
3281 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3282 {
3283 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3284 continue;
3285
3286 if (bl->inserted)
3287 {
3288 bl->inserted = 0;
3289 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &dummy1, &dummy2, &dummy3);
3290 if (val != 0)
3291 {
3292 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3293 return val;
3294 }
3295 }
3296 }
3297 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3298 return 0;
3299 }
3300
3301 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3302
3303 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3304 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3305 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3306 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3307 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3308 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3309 static void
3310 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3311 {
3312 if (internal)
3313 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3314 else
3315 {
3316 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3317 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3318 }
3319 }
3320
3321 static struct breakpoint *
3322 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3323 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3324 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3325 {
3326 struct symtab_and_line sal;
3327 struct breakpoint *b;
3328
3329 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
3330
3331 sal.pc = address;
3332 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3333 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3334
3335 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3336 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3337 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3338
3339 return b;
3340 }
3341
3342 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3343 {
3344 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3345 };
3346 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3347
3348 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3349 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3350 {
3351 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3352 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym;
3353
3354 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3355 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES];
3356
3357 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3358 int longjmp_searched;
3359
3360 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). */
3361 VEC (probe_p) *longjmp_probes;
3362
3363 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3364 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym;
3365
3366 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3367 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym;
3368
3369 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3370 int exception_searched;
3371
3372 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). */
3373 VEC (probe_p) *exception_probes;
3374 };
3375
3376 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
3377
3378 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3379 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3380
3381 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3382
3383 static int
3384 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3385 {
3386 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3387 }
3388
3389 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3390 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3391
3392 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3393 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3394 {
3395 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3396
3397 bp_objfile_data = ((struct breakpoint_objfile_data *)
3398 objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key));
3399 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3400 {
3401 bp_objfile_data =
3402 XOBNEW (&objfile->objfile_obstack, struct breakpoint_objfile_data);
3403
3404 memset (bp_objfile_data, 0, sizeof (*bp_objfile_data));
3405 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
3406 }
3407 return bp_objfile_data;
3408 }
3409
3410 static void
3411 free_breakpoint_probes (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
3412 {
3413 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3414 = (struct breakpoint_objfile_data *) data;
3415
3416 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes);
3417 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->exception_probes);
3418 }
3419
3420 static void
3421 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3422 {
3423 struct objfile *objfile;
3424 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3425
3426 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3427 {
3428 struct breakpoint *b;
3429 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3430 CORE_ADDR addr;
3431 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3432
3433 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3434
3435 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3436 continue;
3437
3438 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3439 {
3440 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3441
3442 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3443 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3444 {
3445 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3446 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3447 continue;
3448 }
3449 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3450 }
3451
3452 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3453 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3454 bp_overlay_event,
3455 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3456 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3457 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3458 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3459
3460 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3461 {
3462 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3463 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3464 }
3465 else
3466 {
3467 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3468 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3469 }
3470 }
3471 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
3472 }
3473
3474 static void
3475 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3476 {
3477 struct program_space *pspace;
3478 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3479
3480 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3481
3482 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3483 {
3484 struct objfile *objfile;
3485
3486 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3487
3488 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3489 {
3490 int i;
3491 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3492 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3493
3494 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3495
3496 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3497
3498 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3499 {
3500 VEC (probe_p) *ret;
3501
3502 ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3503 if (ret != NULL)
3504 {
3505 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3506 struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0);
3507
3508 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3509 {
3510 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3511 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3512 VEC_free (probe_p, ret);
3513 ret = NULL;
3514 }
3515 }
3516 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3517 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3518 }
3519
3520 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes != NULL)
3521 {
3522 int i;
3523 struct probe *probe;
3524 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3525
3526 for (i = 0;
3527 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3528 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes,
3529 i, probe);
3530 ++i)
3531 {
3532 struct breakpoint *b;
3533
3534 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3535 get_probe_address (probe,
3536 objfile),
3537 bp_longjmp_master,
3538 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3539 b->location
3540 = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3541 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3542 }
3543
3544 continue;
3545 }
3546
3547 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3548 continue;
3549
3550 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3551 {
3552 struct breakpoint *b;
3553 const char *func_name;
3554 CORE_ADDR addr;
3555 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3556
3557 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3558 continue;
3559
3560 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3561 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3562 {
3563 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3564
3565 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3566 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3567 {
3568 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3569 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3570 continue;
3571 }
3572 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3573 }
3574
3575 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3576 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3577 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3578 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3579 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3580 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3581 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3582 }
3583 }
3584 }
3585 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
3586
3587 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3588 }
3589
3590 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3591 static void
3592 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3593 {
3594 struct program_space *pspace;
3595 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3596 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3597
3598 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3599
3600 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3601 {
3602 struct objfile *objfile;
3603 CORE_ADDR addr;
3604
3605 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3606
3607 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3608 {
3609 struct breakpoint *b;
3610 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3611 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3612
3613 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3614
3615 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3616 continue;
3617
3618 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3619 {
3620 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3621
3622 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3623 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3624 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3625 {
3626 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3627 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3628 continue;
3629 }
3630 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3631 }
3632
3633 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3634 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3635 bp_std_terminate_master,
3636 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3637 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3638 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3639 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3640 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3641 }
3642 }
3643
3644 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
3645
3646 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3647 }
3648
3649 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3650
3651 static void
3652 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3653 {
3654 struct objfile *objfile;
3655 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3656
3657 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3658 {
3659 struct breakpoint *b;
3660 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3661 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3662 CORE_ADDR addr;
3663 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3664
3665 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3666
3667 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3668 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3669 {
3670 VEC (probe_p) *ret;
3671
3672 ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3673
3674 if (ret != NULL)
3675 {
3676 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3677 struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0);
3678
3679 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3680 {
3681 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3682 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3683 VEC_free (probe_p, ret);
3684 ret = NULL;
3685 }
3686 }
3687 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3688 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3689 }
3690
3691 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes != NULL)
3692 {
3693 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3694 int i;
3695 struct probe *probe;
3696
3697 for (i = 0;
3698 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3699 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes,
3700 i, probe);
3701 ++i)
3702 {
3703 struct breakpoint *b;
3704
3705 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3706 get_probe_address (probe,
3707 objfile),
3708 bp_exception_master,
3709 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3710 b->location
3711 = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3712 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3713 }
3714
3715 continue;
3716 }
3717
3718 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3719
3720 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3721 continue;
3722
3723 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3724
3725 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3726 {
3727 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3728
3729 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3730 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3731 {
3732 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3733 continue;
3734 }
3735
3736 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3737 }
3738
3739 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3740 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3741 &current_target);
3742 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3743 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3744 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3745 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3746 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3747 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3748 }
3749
3750 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
3751 }
3752
3753 void
3754 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3755 {
3756 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3757 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3758
3759 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3760 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3761 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3762 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3763 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3764 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3765 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3766 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3767 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3768 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3769 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3770
3771 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3772 {
3773 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3774 continue;
3775
3776 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3777 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3778 {
3779 delete_breakpoint (b);
3780 continue;
3781 }
3782
3783 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3784 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3785 {
3786 delete_breakpoint (b);
3787 continue;
3788 }
3789
3790 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3791 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3792 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3793 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3794 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3795 {
3796 delete_breakpoint (b);
3797 continue;
3798 }
3799
3800 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3801 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3802 {
3803 delete_breakpoint (b);
3804 continue;
3805 }
3806
3807 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3808 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3809 {
3810 delete_breakpoint (b);
3811 continue;
3812 }
3813
3814 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3815 after an exec. */
3816 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3817 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3818 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3819 {
3820 delete_breakpoint (b);
3821 continue;
3822 }
3823
3824 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3825 {
3826 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3827 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3828 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3829 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3830 continue;
3831 }
3832
3833 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3834 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3835 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3836 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3837 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3838 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3839
3840 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3841 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3842 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3843 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3844 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3845 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3846 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3847
3848 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3849 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3850 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3851 let finish_command delete it.
3852
3853 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3854 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3855 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3856 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3857 solib breakpoints.) */
3858
3859 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3860 {
3861 continue;
3862 }
3863
3864 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3865 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3866 a.out. */
3867 if (event_location_empty_p (b->location))
3868 {
3869 delete_breakpoint (b);
3870 continue;
3871 }
3872 }
3873 }
3874
3875 int
3876 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3877 {
3878 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3879 int val = 0;
3880 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3881 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3882
3883 if (ptid_get_pid (ptid) == ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid))
3884 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3885
3886 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3887 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3888 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3889 {
3890 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3891 continue;
3892
3893 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3894 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3895 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3896 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3897 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3898 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3899 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3900 continue;
3901
3902 if (bl->inserted)
3903 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, mark_inserted);
3904 }
3905
3906 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3907 return val;
3908 }
3909
3910 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3911 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3912 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3913 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3914 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3915
3916 static int
3917 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
3918 {
3919 int val;
3920
3921 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3922 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3923
3924 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3925 This should not ever happen. */
3926 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3927
3928 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3929 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3930 {
3931 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3932 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3933 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3934
3935 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3936 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3937 || bl->section == NULL
3938 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3939 {
3940 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3941
3942 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3943 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3944 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3945 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3946 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3947 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3948 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3949 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3950 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3951 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3952 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3953 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3954 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3955 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3956 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3957 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3958 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3959 they should always be removed. */
3960 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3961 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3962 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3963 val = 0;
3964 else
3965 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3966 }
3967 else
3968 {
3969 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3970 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3971 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3972 {
3973 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3974 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3975 */
3976 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3977 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3978 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3979 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3980 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3981 else
3982 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3983 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3984 }
3985 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3986 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3987 if (bl->inserted)
3988 {
3989 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3990 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3991 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3992 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3993
3994 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3995 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3996 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3997 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3998 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3999 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
4000 else
4001 val = 0;
4002 }
4003 else
4004 {
4005 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
4006 val = 0;
4007 }
4008 }
4009
4010 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
4011 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
4012 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
4013 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
4014 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
4015 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
4016 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
4017 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
4018 always-inserted mode. */
4019 if (val
4020 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4021 && (bl->shlib_disabled
4022 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
4023 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
4024 bl->address))))
4025 val = 0;
4026
4027 if (val)
4028 return val;
4029 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
4030 }
4031 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
4032 {
4033 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
4034 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
4035
4036 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
4037 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
4038
4039 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
4040 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (bl->inserted))
4041 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
4042 bl->owner->number);
4043 }
4044 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
4045 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4046 && !bl->duplicate)
4047 {
4048 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
4049 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
4050
4051 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
4052 if (val)
4053 return val;
4054
4055 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
4056 }
4057
4058 return 0;
4059 }
4060
4061 static int
4062 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
4063 {
4064 int ret;
4065 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4066
4067 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
4068 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
4069
4070 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
4071 This should not ever happen. */
4072 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
4073
4074 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
4075
4076 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
4077
4078 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, is);
4079
4080 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4081 return ret;
4082 }
4083
4084 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
4085
4086 void
4087 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
4088 {
4089 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4090
4091 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4092 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
4093 bl->inserted = 0;
4094 }
4095
4096 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
4097 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
4098
4099 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
4100 between runs.
4101
4102 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
4103 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
4104 init_wait_for_inferior). */
4105
4106
4107
4108 void
4109 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
4110 {
4111 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
4112 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4113 int ix;
4114 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
4115
4116 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
4117 nothing to do. */
4118 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
4119 return;
4120
4121 mark_breakpoints_out ();
4122
4123 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
4124 {
4125 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
4126 continue;
4127
4128 switch (b->type)
4129 {
4130 case bp_call_dummy:
4131 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
4132
4133 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
4134 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
4135 rid of it. */
4136
4137 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4138
4139 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
4140
4141 case bp_shlib_event:
4142
4143 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
4144 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
4145 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
4146 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
4147 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
4148
4149 (gdb) file prog-linux
4150 (gdb) run # native linux target
4151 ...
4152 (gdb) kill
4153 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
4154 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
4155 */
4156
4157 case bp_step_resume:
4158
4159 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
4160
4161 case bp_single_step:
4162
4163 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
4164
4165 delete_breakpoint (b);
4166 break;
4167
4168 case bp_watchpoint:
4169 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4170 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4171 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4172 {
4173 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4174
4175 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
4176 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
4177 delete_breakpoint (b);
4178 else if (context == inf_starting)
4179 {
4180 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
4181 insert_breakpoints. */
4182 if (w->val)
4183 value_free (w->val);
4184 w->val = NULL;
4185 w->val_valid = 0;
4186 }
4187 }
4188 break;
4189 default:
4190 break;
4191 }
4192 }
4193
4194 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
4195 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix)
4196 decref_bp_location (&bl);
4197 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
4198 }
4199
4200 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
4201 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
4202 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
4203 match, not program space. */
4204
4205 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
4206 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
4207 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
4208 permanent breakpoint.
4209 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
4210 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
4211 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
4212 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
4213 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
4214
4215 enum breakpoint_here
4216 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4217 {
4218 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4219 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
4220
4221 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4222 {
4223 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4224 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4225 continue;
4226
4227 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
4228 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4229 || bl->permanent)
4230 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4231 {
4232 if (overlay_debugging
4233 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4234 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4235 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4236 else if (bl->permanent)
4237 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
4238 else
4239 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
4240 }
4241 }
4242
4243 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
4244 }
4245
4246 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4247
4248 int
4249 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4250 {
4251 struct bp_location *loc;
4252 int ix;
4253
4254 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4255 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4256 return 1;
4257
4258 return 0;
4259 }
4260
4261 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4262 ASPACE. */
4263
4264 static int
4265 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4266 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4267 {
4268 if (bl->inserted
4269 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4270 aspace, pc))
4271 {
4272 if (overlay_debugging
4273 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4274 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4275 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4276 else
4277 return 1;
4278 }
4279 return 0;
4280 }
4281
4282 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4283
4284 int
4285 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4286 {
4287 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4288 struct bp_location *bl;
4289
4290 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4291 {
4292 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4293
4294 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4295 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4296 continue;
4297
4298 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4299 return 1;
4300 }
4301 return 0;
4302 }
4303
4304 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4305 inserted at PC. */
4306
4307 int
4308 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4309 CORE_ADDR pc)
4310 {
4311 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4312 struct bp_location *bl;
4313
4314 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4315 {
4316 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4317
4318 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4319 continue;
4320
4321 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4322 return 1;
4323 }
4324
4325 return 0;
4326 }
4327
4328 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4329
4330 int
4331 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4332 CORE_ADDR pc)
4333 {
4334 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4335 struct bp_location *bl;
4336
4337 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4338 {
4339 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4340
4341 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4342 continue;
4343
4344 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4345 return 1;
4346 }
4347
4348 return 0;
4349 }
4350
4351 int
4352 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
4353 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4354 {
4355 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4356
4357 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4358 {
4359 struct bp_location *loc;
4360
4361 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4362 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4363 continue;
4364
4365 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4366 continue;
4367
4368 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4369 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4370 {
4371 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4372
4373 /* Check for intersection. */
4374 l = max (loc->address, addr);
4375 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4376 if (l < h)
4377 return 1;
4378 }
4379 }
4380 return 0;
4381 }
4382 \f
4383
4384 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4385 in breakpoint.h. */
4386
4387 int
4388 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4389 {
4390 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4391 }
4392
4393 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4394 'next' chain. */
4395
4396 static void
4397 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
4398 {
4399 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4400 value_free (bs->old_val);
4401 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
4402 decref_bp_location (&bs->bp_location_at);
4403 xfree (bs);
4404 }
4405
4406 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4407 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4408
4409 void
4410 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4411 {
4412 bpstat p;
4413 bpstat q;
4414
4415 if (bsp == 0)
4416 return;
4417 p = *bsp;
4418 while (p != NULL)
4419 {
4420 q = p->next;
4421 bpstat_free (p);
4422 p = q;
4423 }
4424 *bsp = NULL;
4425 }
4426
4427 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4428 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4429
4430 bpstat
4431 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4432 {
4433 bpstat p = NULL;
4434 bpstat tmp;
4435 bpstat retval = NULL;
4436
4437 if (bs == NULL)
4438 return bs;
4439
4440 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4441 {
4442 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
4443 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
4444 incref_counted_command_line (tmp->commands);
4445 incref_bp_location (tmp->bp_location_at);
4446 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4447 {
4448 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
4449 release_value (tmp->old_val);
4450 }
4451
4452 if (p == NULL)
4453 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4454 retval = tmp;
4455 else
4456 p->next = tmp;
4457 p = tmp;
4458 }
4459 p->next = NULL;
4460 return retval;
4461 }
4462
4463 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4464
4465 bpstat
4466 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4467 {
4468 if (bsp == NULL)
4469 return NULL;
4470
4471 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4472 {
4473 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4474 return bsp;
4475 }
4476 return NULL;
4477 }
4478
4479 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4480
4481 int
4482 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4483 {
4484 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4485 {
4486 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4487 {
4488 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4489 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4490 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4491 return 1;
4492 }
4493 else
4494 {
4495 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4496 sig))
4497 return 1;
4498 }
4499 }
4500
4501 return 0;
4502 }
4503
4504 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4505 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4506 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4507 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4508
4509 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4510 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4511 we set it.
4512 Return 1 otherwise. */
4513
4514 int
4515 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4516 {
4517 struct breakpoint *b;
4518
4519 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4520 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4521
4522 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4523 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4524 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4525 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4526 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4527 if (b == NULL)
4528 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4529
4530 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4531 return 1;
4532 }
4533
4534 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4535
4536 void
4537 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4538 {
4539 struct thread_info *tp;
4540 bpstat bs;
4541
4542 if (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4543 return;
4544
4545 tp = find_thread_ptid (inferior_ptid);
4546 if (tp == NULL)
4547 return;
4548
4549 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4550 {
4551 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
4552
4553 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4554 {
4555 value_free (bs->old_val);
4556 bs->old_val = NULL;
4557 }
4558 }
4559 }
4560
4561 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4562
4563 static void
4564 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4565 {
4566 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4567 {
4568 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4569
4570 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4571 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4572 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4573 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4574 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4575 return;
4576 }
4577
4578 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4579 }
4580
4581 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint
4582 command. */
4583 static void
4584 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
4585 {
4586 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
4587 }
4588
4589 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4590 or its equivalent. */
4591
4592 static int
4593 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4594 {
4595 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4596 }
4597
4598 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4599 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4600 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4601 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4602
4603 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4604 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4605 bpstat of the current thread. */
4606
4607 static int
4608 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4609 {
4610 bpstat bs;
4611 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4612 int again = 0;
4613
4614 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4615 in bs->commands. */
4616 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4617 return 0;
4618
4619 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
4620 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
4621
4622 prevent_dont_repeat ();
4623
4624 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4625 bs = *bsp;
4626
4627 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4628 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4629 {
4630 struct counted_command_line *ccmd;
4631 struct command_line *cmd;
4632 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
4633
4634 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4635
4636 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4637 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4638 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4639 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4640 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4641 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4642 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4643 the tree when we're done. */
4644 ccmd = bs->commands;
4645 bs->commands = NULL;
4646 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&ccmd);
4647 cmd = ccmd ? ccmd->commands : NULL;
4648 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4649 {
4650 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4651 cmd = cmd->next;
4652 }
4653
4654 while (cmd != NULL)
4655 {
4656 execute_control_command (cmd);
4657
4658 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4659 break;
4660 else
4661 cmd = cmd->next;
4662 }
4663
4664 /* We can free this command tree now. */
4665 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
4666
4667 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4668 {
4669 if (interpreter_async)
4670 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4671 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4672 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4673 ;
4674 else
4675 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4676 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4677 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4678 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4679 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4680 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4681 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4682 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4683 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4684 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4685 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4686 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4687 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4688 again = 1;
4689 break;
4690 }
4691 }
4692 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4693 return again;
4694 }
4695
4696 void
4697 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4698 {
4699 struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup ();
4700
4701 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4702 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
4703 && target_has_execution
4704 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
4705 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
4706 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
4707 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
4708 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
4709 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4710 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->control.stop_bpstat))
4711 break;
4712
4713 discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error);
4714 }
4715
4716 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4717
4718 static void
4719 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4720 {
4721 if (val == NULL)
4722 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4723 else
4724 {
4725 struct value_print_options opts;
4726 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4727 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4728 }
4729 }
4730
4731 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4732 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4733 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4734 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4735 normal_stop(). */
4736
4737 static enum print_stop_action
4738 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4739 {
4740 switch (bs->print_it)
4741 {
4742 case print_it_noop:
4743 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4744 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4745 break;
4746
4747 case print_it_done:
4748 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4749 relevant messages. */
4750 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4751 break;
4752
4753 case print_it_normal:
4754 {
4755 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4756
4757 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4758 which has since been deleted. */
4759 if (b == NULL)
4760 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4761
4762 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4763 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4764 }
4765 break;
4766
4767 default:
4768 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4769 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4770 break;
4771 }
4772 }
4773
4774 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4775
4776 static void
4777 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4778 {
4779 int any_deleted
4780 = !VEC_empty (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs);
4781 int any_added
4782 = !VEC_empty (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs);
4783
4784 if (!is_catchpoint)
4785 {
4786 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4787 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4788 _("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4789 else
4790 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4791 _("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4792 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4793 }
4794
4795 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
4796 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "reason",
4797 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4798
4799 if (any_deleted)
4800 {
4801 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4802 char *name;
4803 int ix;
4804
4805 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior unloaded "));
4806 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4807 "removed");
4808 for (ix = 0;
4809 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
4810 ix, name);
4811 ++ix)
4812 {
4813 if (ix > 0)
4814 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4815 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", name);
4816 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4817 }
4818
4819 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4820 }
4821
4822 if (any_added)
4823 {
4824 struct so_list *iter;
4825 int ix;
4826 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4827
4828 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior loaded "));
4829 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4830 "added");
4831 for (ix = 0;
4832 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
4833 ix, iter);
4834 ++ix)
4835 {
4836 if (ix > 0)
4837 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4838 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", iter->so_name);
4839 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4840 }
4841
4842 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4843 }
4844 }
4845
4846 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4847 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4848 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4849 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4850 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4851 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4852 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4853 routine is one of:
4854
4855 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4856 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4857 code to print the location. An example is
4858 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4859 the location.
4860 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4861 to also print the location part of the message.
4862 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4863 don't require a location appended to the end.
4864 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4865 further info to be printed. */
4866
4867 enum print_stop_action
4868 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4869 {
4870 enum print_stop_action val;
4871
4872 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4873 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4874 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4875 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4876 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4877 {
4878 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4879 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4880 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4881 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4882 return val;
4883 }
4884
4885 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4886 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4887 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4888 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4889 {
4890 print_solib_event (0);
4891 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4892 }
4893
4894 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4895 with and nothing was printed. */
4896 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4897 }
4898
4899 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
4900 This returns the inverse of the condition because it is called
4901 from catch_errors which returns 0 if an exception happened, and if an
4902 exception happens we want execution to stop.
4903 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to a
4904 "void *" to make it pass through catch_errors. */
4905
4906 static int
4907 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
4908 {
4909 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4910 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
4911
4912 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4913 return i;
4914 }
4915
4916 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4917
4918 static bpstat
4919 bpstat_alloc (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4920 {
4921 bpstat bs;
4922
4923 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
4924 bs->next = NULL;
4925 **bs_link_pointer = bs;
4926 *bs_link_pointer = &bs->next;
4927 bs->breakpoint_at = bl->owner;
4928 bs->bp_location_at = bl;
4929 incref_bp_location (bl);
4930 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
4931 bs->commands = NULL;
4932 bs->old_val = NULL;
4933 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
4934 return bs;
4935 }
4936 \f
4937 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4938 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4939
4940 int
4941 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4942 {
4943 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4944 CORE_ADDR addr;
4945 struct breakpoint *b;
4946
4947 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4948 {
4949 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4950 as not triggered. */
4951 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4952 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4953 {
4954 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4955
4956 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4957 }
4958
4959 return 0;
4960 }
4961
4962 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
4963 {
4964 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4965 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4966 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4967 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4968 {
4969 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4970
4971 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4972 }
4973
4974 return 1;
4975 }
4976
4977 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4978 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4979 triggered. */
4980
4981 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4982 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4983 {
4984 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4985 struct bp_location *loc;
4986
4987 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4988 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4989 {
4990 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4991 {
4992 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4993 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4994
4995 if (newaddr == start)
4996 {
4997 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4998 break;
4999 }
5000 }
5001 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
5002 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
5003 addr, loc->address,
5004 loc->length))
5005 {
5006 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5007 break;
5008 }
5009 }
5010 }
5011
5012 return 1;
5013 }
5014
5015 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
5016 because of check_errors). */
5017 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
5018 #define WP_DELETED 1
5019 /* The value has changed. */
5020 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
5021 /* The value has not changed. */
5022 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
5023 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
5024 #define WP_IGNORE 4
5025
5026 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
5027 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
5028
5029 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
5030 changed.
5031
5032 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
5033 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
5034
5035 static int
5036 watchpoint_check (void *p)
5037 {
5038 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
5039 struct watchpoint *b;
5040 struct frame_info *fr;
5041 int within_current_scope;
5042
5043 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
5044 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
5045 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5046
5047 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
5048 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
5049 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
5050 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
5051 return WP_IGNORE;
5052
5053 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
5054 within_current_scope = 1;
5055 else
5056 {
5057 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
5058 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5059 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
5060
5061 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
5062 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
5063 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
5064 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
5065 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
5066 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
5067 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
5068 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
5069 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
5070 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
5071 return WP_IGNORE;
5072
5073 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
5074 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
5075
5076 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
5077 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
5078 if (within_current_scope)
5079 {
5080 struct symbol *function;
5081
5082 function = get_frame_function (fr);
5083 if (function == NULL
5084 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
5085 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
5086 within_current_scope = 0;
5087 }
5088
5089 if (within_current_scope)
5090 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
5091 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
5092 the user. */
5093 select_frame (fr);
5094 }
5095
5096 if (within_current_scope)
5097 {
5098 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
5099 time before we return to the command level and call
5100 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
5101 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
5102
5103 int pc = 0;
5104 struct value *mark;
5105 struct value *new_val;
5106
5107 if (is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
5108 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
5109 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
5110 a mask watchpoint. */
5111 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
5112
5113 mark = value_mark ();
5114 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
5115
5116 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
5117 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
5118
5119 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
5120 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
5121 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
5122 not what we want. */
5123 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
5124 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
5125 {
5126 if (new_val != NULL)
5127 {
5128 release_value (new_val);
5129 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5130 }
5131 bs->old_val = b->val;
5132 b->val = new_val;
5133 b->val_valid = 1;
5134 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
5135 }
5136 else
5137 {
5138 /* Nothing changed. */
5139 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5140 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
5141 }
5142 }
5143 else
5144 {
5145 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5146
5147 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
5148 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
5149 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
5150 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
5151 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
5152 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
5153 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
5154 the first value assigned). */
5155 /* We print all the stop information in
5156 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
5157 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
5158 already. So we have no choice but print the information
5159 here. */
5160 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
5161 ui_out_field_string
5162 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
5163 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
5164 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->base.number);
5165 ui_out_text (uiout,
5166 " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
5167 which its expression is valid.\n");
5168
5169 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
5170 decref_counted_command_line (&b->base.commands);
5171 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5172
5173 return WP_DELETED;
5174 }
5175 }
5176
5177 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
5178 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
5179 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
5180
5181 static int
5182 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
5183 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5184 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5185 {
5186 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
5187
5188 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
5189 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5190
5191 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5192 }
5193
5194 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
5195 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
5196
5197 static void
5198 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
5199 {
5200 const struct bp_location *bl;
5201 struct watchpoint *b;
5202
5203 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5204 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5205 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5206 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5207 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5208
5209 {
5210 int must_check_value = 0;
5211
5212 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
5213 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5214 watched value. */
5215 must_check_value = 1;
5216 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5217 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5218 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5219 this watchpoint. */
5220 must_check_value = 1;
5221 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5222 && b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5223 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5224 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5225 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5226 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5227 must_check_value = 1;
5228
5229 if (must_check_value)
5230 {
5231 char *message
5232 = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
5233 b->base.number);
5234 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
5235 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
5236 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5237 do_cleanups (cleanups);
5238 switch (e)
5239 {
5240 case WP_DELETED:
5241 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5242 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5243 /* Stop. */
5244 break;
5245 case WP_IGNORE:
5246 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5247 bs->stop = 0;
5248 break;
5249 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5250 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5251 {
5252 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5253
5254 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5255 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5256 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5257 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5258 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5259 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5260 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5261 old value.
5262
5263 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5264 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5265 happen:
5266
5267 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5268 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5269 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5270 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5271
5272 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5273 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5274 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5275 watchpoint.
5276
5277 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5278 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5279 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5280 changes. This still gives false positives when
5281 the program writes the same value to memory as
5282 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5283 it for a read), but it's much better than
5284 nothing. */
5285
5286 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5287
5288 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5289 {
5290 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5291
5292 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5293 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5294 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5295 {
5296 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5297 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5298
5299 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5300 == watch_triggered_yes)
5301 {
5302 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5303 break;
5304 }
5305 }
5306 }
5307
5308 if (other_write_watchpoint
5309 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5310 {
5311 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5312 and the value changed since the last time we
5313 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5314 Ignore it. */
5315 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5316 bs->stop = 0;
5317 }
5318 }
5319 break;
5320 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5321 if (b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5322 || b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
5323 {
5324 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5325 the value hasn't changed. */
5326 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5327 bs->stop = 0;
5328 }
5329 /* Stop. */
5330 break;
5331 default:
5332 /* Can't happen. */
5333 case 0:
5334 /* Error from catch_errors. */
5335 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->base.number);
5336 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5337 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5338 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5339 break;
5340 }
5341 }
5342 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5343 {
5344 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5345 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5346 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5347 anything for this watchpoint. */
5348 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5349 bs->stop = 0;
5350 }
5351 }
5352 }
5353
5354 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5355 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5356 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5357 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5358
5359 static void
5360 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
5361 {
5362 const struct bp_location *bl;
5363 struct breakpoint *b;
5364 int value_is_zero = 0;
5365 struct expression *cond;
5366
5367 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5368
5369 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5370 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5371 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5372 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5373 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5374
5375 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5376 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5377 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5378
5379 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5380 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5381 {
5382 bs->stop = 0;
5383 return;
5384 }
5385
5386 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5387 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5388 thread/task. */
5389 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != pid_to_thread_id (ptid))
5390 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (ptid)))
5391
5392 {
5393 bs->stop = 0;
5394 return;
5395 }
5396
5397 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5398 implemented. */
5399 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5400
5401 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5402 {
5403 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5404
5405 cond = w->cond_exp;
5406 }
5407 else
5408 cond = bl->cond;
5409
5410 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5411 {
5412 int within_current_scope = 1;
5413 struct watchpoint * w;
5414
5415 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5416 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5417 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5418 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5419 function call. */
5420 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5421
5422 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5423 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5424 else
5425 w = NULL;
5426
5427 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5428 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5429 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5430 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5431 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5432 call site. */
5433 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5434 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5435 else
5436 {
5437 struct frame_info *frame;
5438
5439 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5440 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5441 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5442 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5443 really matter which instantiation of the function
5444 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5445 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5446 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5447 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5448 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5449 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5450 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5451 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5452 intuitive. */
5453 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5454 if (frame != NULL)
5455 select_frame (frame);
5456 else
5457 within_current_scope = 0;
5458 }
5459 if (within_current_scope)
5460 value_is_zero
5461 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
5462 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
5463 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5464 else
5465 {
5466 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5467 "in the current scope"));
5468 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5469 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5470 value_is_zero = 0;
5471 }
5472 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5473 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5474 }
5475
5476 if (cond && value_is_zero)
5477 {
5478 bs->stop = 0;
5479 }
5480 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5481 {
5482 b->ignore_count--;
5483 bs->stop = 0;
5484 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5485 ++(b->hit_count);
5486 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5487 }
5488 }
5489
5490 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5491 on the current target. */
5492
5493 static int
5494 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5495 {
5496 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5497 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5498 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5499 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5500 }
5501
5502
5503 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
5504 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
5505
5506 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
5507 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such
5508 that:
5509
5510 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
5511
5512 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
5513
5514 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
5515 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
5516 several reasons concurrently.)
5517
5518 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
5519 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
5520
5521 bpstat
5522 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
5523 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid,
5524 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5525 {
5526 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5527 struct bp_location *bl;
5528 struct bp_location *loc;
5529 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5530 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5531 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
5532 bpstat bs;
5533 int ix;
5534 int need_remove_insert;
5535 int removed_any;
5536
5537 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5538 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5539 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5540 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5541 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5542 inferior function calls. */
5543
5544 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5545 {
5546 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5547 continue;
5548
5549 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5550 {
5551 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5552 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5553 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5554 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5555 checked all locations already. */
5556 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5557 break;
5558
5559 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5560 continue;
5561
5562 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5563 continue;
5564
5565 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5566 matches. */
5567
5568 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5569 explain stop. */
5570
5571 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5572 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5573 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5574 bs->stop = 1;
5575 bs->print = 1;
5576
5577 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5578 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5579 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5580 iteration. */
5581 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5582 {
5583 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5584
5585 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5586 }
5587 }
5588 }
5589
5590 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5591 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5592 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5593 {
5594 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
5595 {
5596 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5597 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5598 {
5599 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, &bs_link);
5600 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5601 bs->stop = 0;
5602 bs->print = 0;
5603 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5604 }
5605 }
5606 }
5607
5608 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5609 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5610 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5611 "catch unload". */
5612 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5613 {
5614 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5615 {
5616 handle_solib_event ();
5617 break;
5618 }
5619 }
5620
5621 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5622 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5623 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5624
5625 removed_any = 0;
5626
5627 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5628 {
5629 if (!bs->stop)
5630 continue;
5631
5632 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5633 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5634 if (bs->stop)
5635 {
5636 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
5637
5638 if (bs->stop)
5639 {
5640 ++(b->hit_count);
5641 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5642
5643 /* We will stop here. */
5644 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5645 {
5646 --(b->enable_count);
5647 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5648 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5649 removed_any = 1;
5650 }
5651 if (b->silent)
5652 bs->print = 0;
5653 bs->commands = b->commands;
5654 incref_counted_command_line (bs->commands);
5655 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5656 ? bs->commands->commands : NULL))
5657 bs->print = 0;
5658
5659 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5660 }
5661
5662 }
5663
5664 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5665 print. */
5666 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5667 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5668 }
5669
5670 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5671 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5672 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5673 done later. */
5674 need_remove_insert = 0;
5675 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5676 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5677 if (!bs->stop
5678 && bs->breakpoint_at
5679 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5680 {
5681 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5682
5683 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5684 need_remove_insert = 1;
5685 }
5686
5687 if (need_remove_insert)
5688 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5689 else if (removed_any)
5690 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5691
5692 return bs_head;
5693 }
5694
5695 static void
5696 handle_jit_event (void)
5697 {
5698 struct frame_info *frame;
5699 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5700
5701 if (debug_infrun)
5702 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "handling bp_jit_event\n");
5703
5704 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5705 breakpoint_re_set. */
5706 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5707
5708 frame = get_current_frame ();
5709 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5710
5711 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5712
5713 target_terminal_inferior ();
5714 }
5715
5716 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5717
5718 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5719
5720 struct bpstat_what
5721 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5722 {
5723 struct bpstat_what retval;
5724 int jit_event = 0;
5725 bpstat bs;
5726
5727 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5728 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5729 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5730
5731 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5732 {
5733 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5734 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5735 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5736 enum bptype bptype;
5737
5738 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5739 {
5740 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5741 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5742 bptype = bp_none;
5743 }
5744 else
5745 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5746
5747 switch (bptype)
5748 {
5749 case bp_none:
5750 break;
5751 case bp_breakpoint:
5752 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5753 case bp_single_step:
5754 case bp_until:
5755 case bp_finish:
5756 case bp_shlib_event:
5757 if (bs->stop)
5758 {
5759 if (bs->print)
5760 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5761 else
5762 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5763 }
5764 else
5765 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5766 break;
5767 case bp_watchpoint:
5768 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5769 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5770 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5771 if (bs->stop)
5772 {
5773 if (bs->print)
5774 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5775 else
5776 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5777 }
5778 else
5779 {
5780 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5781 This requires no further action. */
5782 }
5783 break;
5784 case bp_longjmp:
5785 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5786 case bp_exception:
5787 if (bs->stop)
5788 {
5789 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5790 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5791 }
5792 else
5793 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5794 break;
5795 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5796 case bp_exception_resume:
5797 if (bs->stop)
5798 {
5799 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5800 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5801 }
5802 else
5803 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5804 break;
5805 case bp_step_resume:
5806 if (bs->stop)
5807 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5808 else
5809 {
5810 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5811 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5812 }
5813 break;
5814 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5815 if (bs->stop)
5816 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5817 else
5818 {
5819 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5820 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5821 }
5822 break;
5823 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5824 case bp_thread_event:
5825 case bp_overlay_event:
5826 case bp_longjmp_master:
5827 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5828 case bp_exception_master:
5829 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5830 break;
5831 case bp_catchpoint:
5832 if (bs->stop)
5833 {
5834 if (bs->print)
5835 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5836 else
5837 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5838 }
5839 else
5840 {
5841 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5842 This requires no further action. */
5843 }
5844 break;
5845 case bp_jit_event:
5846 jit_event = 1;
5847 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5848 break;
5849 case bp_call_dummy:
5850 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5851 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5852 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5853 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5854 break;
5855 case bp_std_terminate:
5856 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5857 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5858 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5859 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5860 break;
5861 case bp_tracepoint:
5862 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5863 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5864 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5865 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5866 out already. */
5867 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5868 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5869 break;
5870 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5871 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5872 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5873 break;
5874 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5875 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5876 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5877 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5878 break;
5879
5880 case bp_dprintf:
5881 if (bs->stop)
5882 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5883 else
5884 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5885 break;
5886
5887 default:
5888 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5889 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5890 }
5891
5892 retval.main_action = max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5893 }
5894
5895 return retval;
5896 }
5897
5898 void
5899 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
5900 {
5901 bpstat bs;
5902
5903 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5904 {
5905 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5906
5907 if (b == NULL)
5908 continue;
5909 switch (b->type)
5910 {
5911 case bp_jit_event:
5912 handle_jit_event ();
5913 break;
5914 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5915 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5916 break;
5917 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5918 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5919 break;
5920 }
5921 }
5922 }
5923
5924 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
5925 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
5926 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
5927
5928 int
5929 bpstat_should_step (void)
5930 {
5931 struct breakpoint *b;
5932
5933 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5934 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5935 return 1;
5936 return 0;
5937 }
5938
5939 int
5940 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5941 {
5942 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5943 if (bs->stop)
5944 return 1;
5945
5946 return 0;
5947 }
5948
5949 \f
5950
5951 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5952 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5953 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5954
5955 static char *
5956 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5957 {
5958 static char wrap_indent[80];
5959 int i, total_width, width, align;
5960 char *text;
5961
5962 total_width = 0;
5963 for (i = 1; ui_out_query_field (uiout, i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5964 {
5965 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5966 {
5967 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5968 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5969 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5970
5971 return wrap_indent;
5972 }
5973
5974 total_width += width + 1;
5975 }
5976
5977 return NULL;
5978 }
5979
5980 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5981 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5982
5983 "host": Host evals condition.
5984 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5985 "target": Target evals condition.
5986 */
5987
5988 static const char *
5989 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5990 {
5991 struct bp_location *bl;
5992 char host_evals = 0;
5993 char target_evals = 0;
5994
5995 if (!b)
5996 return NULL;
5997
5998 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5999 return NULL;
6000
6001 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
6002 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
6003 return condition_evaluation_host;
6004
6005 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
6006 {
6007 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
6008 target_evals++;
6009 else
6010 host_evals++;
6011 }
6012
6013 if (host_evals && target_evals)
6014 return condition_evaluation_both;
6015 else if (target_evals)
6016 return condition_evaluation_target;
6017 else
6018 return condition_evaluation_host;
6019 }
6020
6021 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
6022 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
6023
6024 static const char *
6025 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
6026 {
6027 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
6028 return NULL;
6029
6030 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
6031 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
6032 return condition_evaluation_host;
6033
6034 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
6035 return condition_evaluation_target;
6036 else
6037 return condition_evaluation_host;
6038 }
6039
6040 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
6041
6042 static void
6043 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6044 struct bp_location *loc)
6045 {
6046 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6047 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
6048
6049 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
6050 loc = NULL;
6051
6052 if (loc != NULL)
6053 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
6054
6055 if (b->display_canonical)
6056 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what",
6057 event_location_to_string (b->location));
6058 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
6059 {
6060 struct symbol *sym
6061 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
6062 if (sym)
6063 {
6064 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
6065 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
6066 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
6067 ui_out_text (uiout, " ");
6068 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
6069 ui_out_text (uiout, "at ");
6070 }
6071 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file",
6072 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab));
6073 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
6074
6075 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6076 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname",
6077 symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
6078
6079 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", loc->line_number);
6080 }
6081 else if (loc)
6082 {
6083 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
6084 struct cleanup *stb_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
6085
6086 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb,
6087 demangle, "");
6088 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
6089
6090 do_cleanups (stb_chain);
6091 }
6092 else
6093 {
6094 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending",
6095 event_location_to_string (b->location));
6096 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
6097 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
6098 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
6099 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && b->extra_string != NULL)
6100 {
6101 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
6102 ui_out_text (uiout, ",");
6103 else
6104 ui_out_text (uiout, " ");
6105 ui_out_text (uiout, b->extra_string);
6106 }
6107 }
6108
6109 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
6110 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
6111 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
6112 {
6113 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
6114 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
6115 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
6116 ui_out_text (uiout, ")");
6117 }
6118
6119 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6120 }
6121
6122 static const char *
6123 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
6124 {
6125 struct ep_type_description
6126 {
6127 enum bptype type;
6128 char *description;
6129 };
6130 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
6131 {
6132 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
6133 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
6134 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
6135 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
6136 {bp_until, "until"},
6137 {bp_finish, "finish"},
6138 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
6139 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
6140 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
6141 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
6142 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
6143 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
6144 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
6145 {bp_exception, "exception"},
6146 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
6147 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
6148 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
6149 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
6150 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
6151 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
6152 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
6153 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
6154 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
6155 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
6156 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
6157 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
6158 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
6159 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
6160 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
6161 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
6162 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
6163 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
6164 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
6165 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
6166 };
6167
6168 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
6169 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
6170 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6171 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
6172 (int) type);
6173
6174 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
6175 }
6176
6177 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
6178 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
6179
6180 static void
6181 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
6182 const char *field_name,
6183 VEC(int) *inf_num,
6184 int mi_only)
6185 {
6186 struct cleanup *back_to;
6187 int is_mi = ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout);
6188 int inf;
6189 int i;
6190
6191 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6192 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
6193 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
6194 return;
6195
6196 back_to = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (uiout, field_name);
6197
6198 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (int, inf_num, i, inf); ++i)
6199 {
6200 if (is_mi)
6201 {
6202 char mi_group[10];
6203
6204 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf);
6205 ui_out_field_string (uiout, NULL, mi_group);
6206 }
6207 else
6208 {
6209 if (i == 0)
6210 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
6211 else
6212 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
6213
6214 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf));
6215 }
6216 }
6217
6218 do_cleanups (back_to);
6219 }
6220
6221 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
6222
6223 static void
6224 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6225 struct bp_location *loc,
6226 int loc_number,
6227 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6228 int allflag)
6229 {
6230 struct command_line *l;
6231 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6232
6233 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6234 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6235 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6236 struct value_print_options opts;
6237
6238 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6239
6240 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6241 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6242 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6243 if (loc == NULL
6244 && (b->loc != NULL
6245 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6246 header_of_multiple = 1;
6247 if (loc == NULL)
6248 loc = b->loc;
6249
6250 annotate_record ();
6251
6252 /* 1 */
6253 annotate_field (0);
6254 if (part_of_multiple)
6255 {
6256 char *formatted;
6257 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6258 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
6259 xfree (formatted);
6260 }
6261 else
6262 {
6263 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6264 }
6265
6266 /* 2 */
6267 annotate_field (1);
6268 if (part_of_multiple)
6269 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
6270 else
6271 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptype_string (b->type));
6272
6273 /* 3 */
6274 annotate_field (2);
6275 if (part_of_multiple)
6276 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
6277 else
6278 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6279
6280
6281 /* 4 */
6282 annotate_field (3);
6283 if (part_of_multiple)
6284 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6285 else
6286 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
6287 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6288 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
6289
6290
6291 /* 5 and 6 */
6292 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6293 {
6294 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6295 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6296 make sure there's just one location. */
6297 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6298 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6299 }
6300 else
6301 switch (b->type)
6302 {
6303 case bp_none:
6304 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6305 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6306 break;
6307
6308 case bp_watchpoint:
6309 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6310 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6311 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6312 {
6313 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6314
6315 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6316 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6317 is relatively readable). */
6318 if (opts.addressprint)
6319 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6320 annotate_field (5);
6321 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", w->exp_string);
6322 }
6323 break;
6324
6325 case bp_breakpoint:
6326 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6327 case bp_single_step:
6328 case bp_until:
6329 case bp_finish:
6330 case bp_longjmp:
6331 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6332 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6333 case bp_exception:
6334 case bp_exception_resume:
6335 case bp_step_resume:
6336 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6337 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6338 case bp_call_dummy:
6339 case bp_std_terminate:
6340 case bp_shlib_event:
6341 case bp_thread_event:
6342 case bp_overlay_event:
6343 case bp_longjmp_master:
6344 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6345 case bp_exception_master:
6346 case bp_tracepoint:
6347 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6348 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6349 case bp_dprintf:
6350 case bp_jit_event:
6351 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6352 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6353 if (opts.addressprint)
6354 {
6355 annotate_field (4);
6356 if (header_of_multiple)
6357 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6358 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6359 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
6360 else
6361 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
6362 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6363 }
6364 annotate_field (5);
6365 if (!header_of_multiple)
6366 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6367 if (b->loc)
6368 *last_loc = b->loc;
6369 break;
6370 }
6371
6372
6373 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6374 {
6375 struct inferior *inf;
6376 VEC(int) *inf_num = NULL;
6377 int mi_only = 1;
6378
6379 ALL_INFERIORS (inf)
6380 {
6381 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6382 VEC_safe_push (int, inf_num, inf->num);
6383 }
6384
6385 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6386 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6387 if (allflag
6388 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6389 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6390 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6391 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6392 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6393 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6394 mi_only = 0;
6395 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_num, mi_only);
6396 VEC_free (int, inf_num);
6397 }
6398
6399 if (!part_of_multiple)
6400 {
6401 if (b->thread != -1)
6402 {
6403 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6404 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6405 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
6406 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
6407 }
6408 else if (b->task != 0)
6409 {
6410 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
6411 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
6412 }
6413 }
6414
6415 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6416
6417 if (!part_of_multiple)
6418 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6419
6420 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6421 {
6422 annotate_field (6);
6423 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6424 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6425 the frame ID. */
6426 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
6427 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6428 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6429 }
6430
6431 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6432 {
6433 annotate_field (7);
6434 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6435 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
6436 else
6437 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
6438 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
6439
6440 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6441 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6442 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6443 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6444 == condition_evaluation_target)
6445 {
6446 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
6447 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
6448 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6449 ui_out_text (uiout, " evals)");
6450 }
6451 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6452 }
6453
6454 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6455 {
6456 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6457 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
6458 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
6459 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6460 }
6461
6462 if (!part_of_multiple)
6463 {
6464 if (b->hit_count)
6465 {
6466 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6467 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6468 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
6469 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6470 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttracepoint");
6471 else
6472 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
6473 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
6474 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
6475 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6476 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
6477 else
6478 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
6479 }
6480 else
6481 {
6482 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6483 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6484 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
6485 }
6486 }
6487
6488 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6489 {
6490 annotate_field (8);
6491 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
6492 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
6493 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
6494 }
6495
6496 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6497 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6498 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6499 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6500 {
6501 annotate_field (8);
6502 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tdisable after ");
6503 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6504 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6505 if (b->ignore_count)
6506 ui_out_text (uiout, "additional ");
6507 else
6508 ui_out_text (uiout, "next ");
6509 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "enable", b->enable_count);
6510 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
6511 }
6512
6513 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6514 {
6515 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6516
6517 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6518 {
6519 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace buffer usage ");
6520 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6521 ui_out_text (uiout, " bytes\n");
6522 }
6523 }
6524
6525 l = b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
6526 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6527 {
6528 struct cleanup *script_chain;
6529
6530 annotate_field (9);
6531 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
6532 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6533 do_cleanups (script_chain);
6534 }
6535
6536 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6537 {
6538 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6539
6540 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6541 {
6542 annotate_field (10);
6543 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
6544 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", t->pass_count);
6545 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6546 }
6547
6548 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6549 pending. */
6550 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6551 {
6552 annotate_field (11);
6553
6554 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6555 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "installed",
6556 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6557 else
6558 {
6559 if (loc->inserted)
6560 ui_out_text (uiout, "\t");
6561 else
6562 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tnot ");
6563 ui_out_text (uiout, "installed on target\n");
6564 }
6565 }
6566 }
6567
6568 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
6569 {
6570 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6571 {
6572 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6573
6574 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", w->exp_string);
6575 }
6576 else if (b->location != NULL
6577 && event_location_to_string (b->location) != NULL)
6578 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location",
6579 event_location_to_string (b->location));
6580 }
6581 }
6582
6583 static void
6584 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6585 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6586 int allflag)
6587 {
6588 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
6589 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6590
6591 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
6592
6593 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6594 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
6595
6596 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6597 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6598 locations, if any. */
6599 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6600 {
6601 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6602 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6603 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6604 situation.
6605
6606 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6607 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6608 if (b->loc
6609 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6610 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6611 {
6612 struct bp_location *loc;
6613 int n = 1;
6614
6615 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6616 {
6617 struct cleanup *inner2 =
6618 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, NULL);
6619 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6620 do_cleanups (inner2);
6621 }
6622 }
6623 }
6624 }
6625
6626 static int
6627 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6628 {
6629 int print_address_bits = 0;
6630 struct bp_location *loc;
6631
6632 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6633 {
6634 int addr_bit;
6635
6636 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have
6637 an address to print. */
6638 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && loc->watchpoint_type == -1)
6639 continue;
6640
6641 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6642 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6643 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6644 }
6645
6646 return print_address_bits;
6647 }
6648
6649 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
6650 {
6651 int bnum;
6652 };
6653
6654 static int
6655 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
6656 {
6657 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args
6658 = (struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *) data;
6659 struct breakpoint *b;
6660 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6661
6662 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6663 {
6664 if (args->bnum == b->number)
6665 {
6666 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6667 return GDB_RC_OK;
6668 }
6669 }
6670 return GDB_RC_NONE;
6671 }
6672
6673 enum gdb_rc
6674 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum,
6675 char **error_message)
6676 {
6677 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
6678
6679 args.bnum = bnum;
6680 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
6681 an error. */
6682 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
6683 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
6684 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
6685 else
6686 return GDB_RC_OK;
6687 }
6688
6689 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6690 internal or momentary. */
6691
6692 int
6693 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6694 {
6695 return b->number > 0;
6696 }
6697
6698 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6699 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6700 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6701 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6702 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6703 breakpoints listed. */
6704
6705 static int
6706 breakpoint_1 (char *args, int allflag,
6707 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6708 {
6709 struct breakpoint *b;
6710 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6711 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6712 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
6713 struct value_print_options opts;
6714 int print_address_bits = 0;
6715 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6716 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6717
6718 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6719
6720 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6721 required for address fields. */
6722 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6723 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6724 {
6725 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6726 if (filter && !filter (b))
6727 continue;
6728
6729 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6730 accept. Skip the others. */
6731 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6732 {
6733 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6734 continue;
6735 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6736 continue;
6737 }
6738
6739 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6740 {
6741 int addr_bit, type_len;
6742
6743 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6744 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6745 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6746
6747 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6748 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6749 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6750
6751 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6752 }
6753 }
6754
6755 if (opts.addressprint)
6756 bkpttbl_chain
6757 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6,
6758 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6759 "BreakpointTable");
6760 else
6761 bkpttbl_chain
6762 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5,
6763 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6764 "BreakpointTable");
6765
6766 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6767 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6768 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6769 annotate_field (0);
6770 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6771 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6772 annotate_field (1);
6773 ui_out_table_header (uiout, print_type_col_width, ui_left,
6774 "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6775 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6776 annotate_field (2);
6777 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6778 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6779 annotate_field (3);
6780 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6781 if (opts.addressprint)
6782 {
6783 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6784 annotate_field (4);
6785 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6786 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left,
6787 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6788 else
6789 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left,
6790 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6791 }
6792 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6793 annotate_field (5);
6794 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6795 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
6796 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6797 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6798
6799 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6800 {
6801 QUIT;
6802 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6803 if (filter && !filter (b))
6804 continue;
6805
6806 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6807 accept. Skip the others. */
6808
6809 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6810 {
6811 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6812 {
6813 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6814 continue;
6815 }
6816 else /* all others */
6817 {
6818 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6819 continue;
6820 }
6821 }
6822 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6823 allflag is set. */
6824 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6825 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6826 }
6827
6828 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
6829
6830 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6831 {
6832 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6833 empty list. */
6834 if (!filter)
6835 {
6836 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6837 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6838 else
6839 ui_out_message (uiout, 0,
6840 "No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6841 args);
6842 }
6843 }
6844 else
6845 {
6846 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6847 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6848 }
6849
6850 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6851 there have been breakpoints? */
6852 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6853
6854 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6855 }
6856
6857 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6858 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6859
6860 static void
6861 default_collect_info (void)
6862 {
6863 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6864
6865 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6866 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6867 not wanted. */
6868 if (!*default_collect)
6869 return;
6870
6871 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6872 actions. */
6873 ui_out_text (uiout, "default collect ");
6874 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "default-collect", default_collect);
6875 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6876 }
6877
6878 static void
6879 breakpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
6880 {
6881 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
6882
6883 default_collect_info ();
6884 }
6885
6886 static void
6887 watchpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
6888 {
6889 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
6890 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6891
6892 if (num_printed == 0)
6893 {
6894 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6895 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoints.\n");
6896 else
6897 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6898 }
6899 }
6900
6901 static void
6902 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *args, int from_tty)
6903 {
6904 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
6905
6906 default_collect_info ();
6907 }
6908
6909 static int
6910 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6911 struct program_space *pspace,
6912 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6913 {
6914 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6915
6916 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6917 {
6918 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6919 && bl->address == pc
6920 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6921 return 1;
6922 }
6923 return 0;
6924 }
6925
6926 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6927 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6928 address spaces. */
6929
6930 static void
6931 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6932 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6933 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6934 {
6935 int others = 0;
6936 struct breakpoint *b;
6937
6938 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6939 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6940 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6941 if (others > 0)
6942 {
6943 if (others == 1)
6944 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6945 else /* if (others == ???) */
6946 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6947 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6948 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6949 {
6950 others--;
6951 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6952 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6953 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6954 else if (b->thread != -1)
6955 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6956 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6957 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6958 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6959 ? " (disabled)"
6960 : ""),
6961 (others > 1) ? ","
6962 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6963 }
6964 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
6965 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
6966 printf_filtered (".\n");
6967 }
6968 }
6969 \f
6970
6971 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
6972 BPT locations. For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members
6973 are irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to other
6974 addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6975
6976 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
6977 always have a zero valued location address and we don't want to mark
6978 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
6979 breakpoint location at address zero:
6980
6981 bp_watchpoint
6982 bp_catchpoint
6983
6984 */
6985
6986 static int
6987 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6988 {
6989 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
6990
6991 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
6992 }
6993
6994 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6995 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6996
6997 static int
6998 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6999 struct bp_location *loc2)
7000 {
7001 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
7002 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
7003
7004 /* Both of them must exist. */
7005 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
7006 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
7007
7008 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
7009 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
7010 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
7011 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
7012 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
7013 other watchpoint. */
7014 if ((w1->cond_exp
7015 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
7016 loc1->length,
7017 loc1->watchpoint_type,
7018 w1->cond_exp))
7019 || (w2->cond_exp
7020 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
7021 loc2->length,
7022 loc2->watchpoint_type,
7023 w2->cond_exp)))
7024 return 0;
7025
7026 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
7027 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
7028 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
7029 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
7030 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
7031 become hw_access locations later. */
7032 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
7033 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
7034 && loc1->address == loc2->address
7035 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
7036 }
7037
7038 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7039
7040 int
7041 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
7042 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
7043 {
7044 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
7045 || aspace1 == aspace2)
7046 && addr1 == addr2);
7047 }
7048
7049 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
7050 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
7051 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
7052 space doesn't really matter. */
7053
7054 static int
7055 breakpoint_address_match_range (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
7056 int len1, struct address_space *aspace2,
7057 CORE_ADDR addr2)
7058 {
7059 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
7060 || aspace1 == aspace2)
7061 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
7062 }
7063
7064 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
7065 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
7066 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
7067 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
7068
7069 static int
7070 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
7071 struct address_space *aspace,
7072 CORE_ADDR addr)
7073 {
7074 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
7075 aspace, addr)
7076 || (bl->length
7077 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
7078 bl->address, bl->length,
7079 aspace, addr)));
7080 }
7081
7082 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
7083 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
7084 true, otherwise returns false. */
7085
7086 static int
7087 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
7088 struct bp_location *loc2)
7089 {
7090 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
7091 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
7092 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
7093 different locations. */
7094 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
7095 else
7096 return 0;
7097 }
7098
7099 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
7100 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
7101 represent the same location. */
7102
7103 static int
7104 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
7105 struct bp_location *loc2)
7106 {
7107 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
7108
7109 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
7110 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
7111 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
7112
7113 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
7114 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
7115
7116 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
7117 return 0;
7118 else if (hw_point1)
7119 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
7120 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
7121 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
7122 else
7123 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
7124 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
7125 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
7126 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
7127 }
7128
7129 static void
7130 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
7131 int bnum, int have_bnum)
7132 {
7133 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
7134 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
7135 char astr1[64];
7136 char astr2[64];
7137
7138 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
7139 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
7140 if (have_bnum)
7141 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
7142 bnum, astr1, astr2);
7143 else
7144 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
7145 }
7146
7147 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
7148 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
7149 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
7150 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
7151
7152 static CORE_ADDR
7153 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7154 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
7155 {
7156 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
7157 {
7158 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
7159 return bpaddr;
7160 }
7161 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
7162 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
7163 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
7164 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
7165 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
7166 {
7167 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
7168 have their addresses modified. */
7169 return bpaddr;
7170 }
7171 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
7172 {
7173 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
7174 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
7175 applies to this address, then it should have already been
7176 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
7177 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
7178 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
7179 return bpaddr;
7180 }
7181 else
7182 {
7183 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
7184
7185 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
7186 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
7187 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
7188
7189 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
7190 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
7191 is required. */
7192 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
7193 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
7194
7195 return adjusted_bpaddr;
7196 }
7197 }
7198
7199 void
7200 init_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc, const struct bp_location_ops *ops,
7201 struct breakpoint *owner)
7202 {
7203 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
7204
7205 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7206
7207 loc->ops = ops;
7208 loc->owner = owner;
7209 loc->cond = NULL;
7210 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
7211 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
7212 loc->enabled = 1;
7213
7214 switch (owner->type)
7215 {
7216 case bp_breakpoint:
7217 case bp_single_step:
7218 case bp_until:
7219 case bp_finish:
7220 case bp_longjmp:
7221 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7222 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
7223 case bp_exception:
7224 case bp_exception_resume:
7225 case bp_step_resume:
7226 case bp_hp_step_resume:
7227 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7228 case bp_call_dummy:
7229 case bp_std_terminate:
7230 case bp_shlib_event:
7231 case bp_thread_event:
7232 case bp_overlay_event:
7233 case bp_jit_event:
7234 case bp_longjmp_master:
7235 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7236 case bp_exception_master:
7237 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7238 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7239 case bp_dprintf:
7240 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7241 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7242 break;
7243 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7244 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7245 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7246 break;
7247 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7248 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7249 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7250 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7251 break;
7252 case bp_watchpoint:
7253 case bp_catchpoint:
7254 case bp_tracepoint:
7255 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7256 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7257 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7258 break;
7259 default:
7260 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7261 }
7262
7263 loc->refc = 1;
7264 }
7265
7266 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7267
7268 static struct bp_location *
7269 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7270 {
7271 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7272 }
7273
7274 static void
7275 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7276 {
7277 loc->ops->dtor (loc);
7278 xfree (loc);
7279 }
7280
7281 /* Increment reference count. */
7282
7283 static void
7284 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7285 {
7286 ++bl->refc;
7287 }
7288
7289 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7290 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7291
7292 static void
7293 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7294 {
7295 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7296
7297 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7298 free_bp_location (*blp);
7299 *blp = NULL;
7300 }
7301
7302 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7303
7304 static void
7305 add_to_breakpoint_chain (struct breakpoint *b)
7306 {
7307 struct breakpoint *b1;
7308
7309 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7310 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7311
7312 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7313 if (b1 == 0)
7314 breakpoint_chain = b;
7315 else
7316 {
7317 while (b1->next)
7318 b1 = b1->next;
7319 b1->next = b;
7320 }
7321 }
7322
7323 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7324
7325 static void
7326 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7327 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7328 enum bptype bptype,
7329 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7330 {
7331 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
7332
7333 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7334
7335 b->ops = ops;
7336 b->type = bptype;
7337 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7338 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7339 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7340 b->thread = -1;
7341 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7342 b->next = 0;
7343 b->silent = 0;
7344 b->ignore_count = 0;
7345 b->commands = NULL;
7346 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
7347 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
7348 b->py_bp_object = NULL;
7349 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7350 b->location = NULL;
7351 }
7352
7353 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7354 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7355
7356 static struct breakpoint *
7357 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7358 enum bptype bptype,
7359 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7360 {
7361 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
7362
7363 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7364 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
7365 return b;
7366 }
7367
7368 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7369 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7370 enough. */
7371
7372 static void
7373 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7374 {
7375 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7376
7377 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7378 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7379 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7380 {
7381 int is_gnu_ifunc;
7382 const char *function_name;
7383 CORE_ADDR func_addr;
7384
7385 find_pc_partial_function_gnu_ifunc (loc->address, &function_name,
7386 &func_addr, NULL, &is_gnu_ifunc);
7387
7388 if (is_gnu_ifunc && !explicit_loc)
7389 {
7390 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7391
7392 gdb_assert (loc->pspace == current_program_space);
7393 if (gnu_ifunc_resolve_name (function_name,
7394 &loc->requested_address))
7395 {
7396 /* Recalculate ADDRESS based on new REQUESTED_ADDRESS. */
7397 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
7398 loc->requested_address,
7399 b->type);
7400 }
7401 else if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7402 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7403 {
7404 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7405 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7406 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7407 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7408 breakpoint. */
7409 loc->related_address = func_addr;
7410 }
7411 }
7412
7413 if (function_name)
7414 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7415 }
7416 }
7417
7418 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7419 struct gdbarch *
7420 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7421 {
7422 if (sal.section)
7423 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7424 if (sal.symtab)
7425 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7426
7427 return NULL;
7428 }
7429
7430 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7431 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7432 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7433
7434 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7435 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7436 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7437
7438 static void
7439 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7440 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7441 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7442 {
7443 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7444
7445 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7446
7447 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7448 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7449
7450 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7451 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7452 program space. */
7453 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7454 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7455 }
7456
7457 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7458 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7459 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7460 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7461 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7462 is also returned as the value of this function.
7463
7464 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7465 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7466 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7467 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7468 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7469 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7470 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7471
7472 struct breakpoint *
7473 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7474 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7475 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7476 {
7477 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
7478
7479 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7480 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
7481 return b;
7482 }
7483
7484 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7485 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7486 initiated the operation. */
7487
7488 void
7489 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7490 {
7491 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7492 int thread = tp->num;
7493
7494 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7495 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7496 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7497 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7498 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7499 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7500 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7501 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7502 {
7503 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7504 struct breakpoint *clone;
7505
7506 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7507 after their removal. */
7508 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7509 &longjmp_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7510 clone->thread = thread;
7511 }
7512
7513 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7514 }
7515
7516 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7517 void
7518 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7519 {
7520 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7521
7522 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7523 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7524 {
7525 if (b->thread == thread)
7526 delete_breakpoint (b);
7527 }
7528 }
7529
7530 void
7531 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7532 {
7533 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7534
7535 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7536 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7537 {
7538 if (b->thread == thread)
7539 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7540 }
7541 }
7542
7543 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7544 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7545 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7546 breakpoints. */
7547
7548 struct breakpoint *
7549 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7550 {
7551 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7552
7553 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7554 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7555 {
7556 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7557
7558 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7559 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7560 1);
7561 new_b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
7562
7563 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7564
7565 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7566 if (retval == NULL)
7567 retval = new_b;
7568 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7569 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7570 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7571 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7572 }
7573
7574 return retval;
7575 }
7576
7577 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7578 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7579 stack.
7580
7581 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7582 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7583 frames. */
7584
7585 void
7586 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7587 {
7588 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7589
7590 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7591 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->num)
7592 {
7593 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7594
7595 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7596 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7597 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7598 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7599 continue;
7600
7601 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp->ptid);
7602
7603 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7604 {
7605 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7606 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7607 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7608 }
7609 delete_breakpoint (b);
7610 }
7611 }
7612
7613 void
7614 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7615 {
7616 struct breakpoint *b;
7617
7618 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7619 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7620 {
7621 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7622 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7623 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7624 }
7625 }
7626
7627 void
7628 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7629 {
7630 struct breakpoint *b;
7631
7632 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7633 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7634 {
7635 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7636 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7637 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7638 }
7639 }
7640
7641 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7642 master breakpoint. */
7643 void
7644 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7645 {
7646 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7647
7648 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7649 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7650 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7651 {
7652 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7653 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7654 }
7655 }
7656
7657 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7658 void
7659 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7660 {
7661 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7662
7663 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7664 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7665 delete_breakpoint (b);
7666 }
7667
7668 struct breakpoint *
7669 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7670 {
7671 struct breakpoint *b;
7672
7673 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7674 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7675
7676 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7677 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7678 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address);
7679
7680 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7681
7682 return b;
7683 }
7684
7685 void
7686 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
7687 {
7688 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7689
7690 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7691 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
7692 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7693 delete_breakpoint (b);
7694 }
7695
7696 struct lang_and_radix
7697 {
7698 enum language lang;
7699 int radix;
7700 };
7701
7702 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7703
7704 struct breakpoint *
7705 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7706 {
7707 struct breakpoint *b;
7708
7709 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7710 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7711 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7712 return b;
7713 }
7714
7715 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7716
7717 void
7718 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7719 {
7720 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7721
7722 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7723 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7724 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7725 delete_breakpoint (b);
7726 }
7727
7728 void
7729 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7730 {
7731 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7732
7733 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7734 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7735 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7736 delete_breakpoint (b);
7737 }
7738
7739 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7740
7741 void
7742 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7743 {
7744 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7745
7746 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7747 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7748 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7749 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7750 }
7751
7752 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7753 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7754 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7755
7756 static struct breakpoint *
7757 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7758 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7759 {
7760 struct breakpoint *b;
7761
7762 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7763 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7764 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7765 return b;
7766 }
7767
7768 struct breakpoint *
7769 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7770 {
7771 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7772 }
7773
7774 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7775
7776 struct breakpoint *
7777 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7778 {
7779 struct breakpoint *b;
7780
7781 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7782 locations. */
7783 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7784 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7785 {
7786 delete_breakpoint (b);
7787 return NULL;
7788 }
7789 return b;
7790 }
7791
7792 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7793 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7794
7795 void
7796 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7797 {
7798 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7799
7800 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7801 {
7802 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7803 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7804
7805 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7806 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7807 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7808 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7809 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7810 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7811 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7812 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7813 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7814 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7815 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7816 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7817 )
7818 {
7819 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7820 }
7821 }
7822 }
7823
7824 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7825 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7826 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7827
7828 static void
7829 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7830 {
7831 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7832 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7833
7834 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
7835 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
7836 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
7837 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
7838 if (exec_bfd != NULL
7839 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
7840 return;
7841
7842 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7843 {
7844 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7845 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7846
7847 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7848 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7849 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7850 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7851 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7852 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7853 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7854 || is_tracepoint (b))
7855 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7856 {
7857 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7858 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7859 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7860 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7861 loc->inserted = 0;
7862
7863 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7864 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7865
7866 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7867 {
7868 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
7869 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7870 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7871 solib->so_name);
7872 }
7873 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7874 }
7875 }
7876 }
7877
7878 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7879 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7880 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7881
7882 static void
7883 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7884 {
7885 struct breakpoint *b;
7886
7887 if (objfile == NULL)
7888 return;
7889
7890 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7891 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7892 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7893 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7894 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7895 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7896 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7897 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7898 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7899 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7900 main objfile). */
7901 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7902 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7903 return;
7904
7905 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7906 {
7907 struct bp_location *loc;
7908 int bp_modified = 0;
7909
7910 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7911 continue;
7912
7913 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
7914 {
7915 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7916
7917 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7918 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7919 continue;
7920
7921 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7922 continue;
7923
7924 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7925 continue;
7926
7927 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7928 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7929 continue;
7930
7931 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7932 {
7933 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7934 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7935 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7936 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7937 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7938 unmapped. */
7939
7940 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7941
7942 bp_modified = 1;
7943 }
7944 }
7945
7946 if (bp_modified)
7947 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7948 }
7949 }
7950
7951 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7952
7953 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7954 catchpoint. It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base
7955 class; users downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A
7956 breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7957 CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7958
7959 struct fork_catchpoint
7960 {
7961 /* The base class. */
7962 struct breakpoint base;
7963
7964 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7965 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7966 catchpoint has triggered. */
7967 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7968 };
7969
7970 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7971 catchpoints. */
7972
7973 static int
7974 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7975 {
7976 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7977 }
7978
7979 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7980 catchpoints. */
7981
7982 static int
7983 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7984 {
7985 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7986 }
7987
7988 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7989 catchpoints. */
7990
7991 static int
7992 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7993 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7994 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7995 {
7996 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7997
7998 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7999 return 0;
8000
8001 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
8002 return 1;
8003 }
8004
8005 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8006 catchpoints. */
8007
8008 static enum print_stop_action
8009 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
8010 {
8011 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8012 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8013 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8014
8015 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8016 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8017 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8018 else
8019 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8020 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8021 {
8022 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8023 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
8024 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8025 }
8026 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8027 ui_out_text (uiout, " (forked process ");
8028 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8029 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8030 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8031 }
8032
8033 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8034 catchpoints. */
8035
8036 static void
8037 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8038 {
8039 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8040 struct value_print_options opts;
8041 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8042
8043 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8044
8045 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8046 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8047 readable). */
8048 if (opts.addressprint)
8049 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8050 annotate_field (5);
8051 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
8052 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
8053 {
8054 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
8055 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
8056 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8057 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
8058 }
8059
8060 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8061 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "fork");
8062 }
8063
8064 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8065 catchpoints. */
8066
8067 static void
8068 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
8069 {
8070 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
8071 }
8072
8073 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
8074 catchpoints. */
8075
8076 static void
8077 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8078 {
8079 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
8080 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8081 }
8082
8083 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
8084
8085 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
8086
8087 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8088 catchpoints. */
8089
8090 static int
8091 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
8092 {
8093 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8094 }
8095
8096 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8097 catchpoints. */
8098
8099 static int
8100 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
8101 {
8102 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8103 }
8104
8105 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8106 catchpoints. */
8107
8108 static int
8109 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
8110 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8111 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8112 {
8113 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8114
8115 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
8116 return 0;
8117
8118 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
8119 return 1;
8120 }
8121
8122 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8123 catchpoints. */
8124
8125 static enum print_stop_action
8126 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
8127 {
8128 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8129 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8130 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8131
8132 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8133 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8134 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8135 else
8136 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8137 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8138 {
8139 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8140 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
8141 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8142 }
8143 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8144 ui_out_text (uiout, " (vforked process ");
8145 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8146 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8147 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8148 }
8149
8150 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8151 catchpoints. */
8152
8153 static void
8154 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8155 {
8156 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8157 struct value_print_options opts;
8158 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8159
8160 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8161 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8162 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8163 readable). */
8164 if (opts.addressprint)
8165 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8166 annotate_field (5);
8167 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
8168 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
8169 {
8170 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
8171 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
8172 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8173 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
8174 }
8175
8176 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8177 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "vfork");
8178 }
8179
8180 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8181 catchpoints. */
8182
8183 static void
8184 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
8185 {
8186 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
8187 }
8188
8189 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8190 catchpoints. */
8191
8192 static void
8193 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8194 {
8195 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
8196 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8197 }
8198
8199 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
8200
8201 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
8202
8203 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
8204 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8205 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8206 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8207 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8208
8209 struct solib_catchpoint
8210 {
8211 /* The base class. */
8212 struct breakpoint base;
8213
8214 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
8215 unsigned char is_load;
8216
8217 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
8218 REGEX is non-NULL. */
8219 char *regex;
8220 regex_t compiled;
8221 };
8222
8223 static void
8224 dtor_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8225 {
8226 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8227
8228 if (self->regex)
8229 regfree (&self->compiled);
8230 xfree (self->regex);
8231
8232 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8233 }
8234
8235 static int
8236 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8237 {
8238 return 0;
8239 }
8240
8241 static int
8242 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8243 {
8244 return 0;
8245 }
8246
8247 static int
8248 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
8249 struct address_space *aspace,
8250 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8251 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8252 {
8253 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8254 struct breakpoint *other;
8255
8256 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
8257 return 1;
8258
8259 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
8260 {
8261 struct bp_location *other_bl;
8262
8263 if (other == bl->owner)
8264 continue;
8265
8266 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
8267 continue;
8268
8269 if (self->base.pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->base.pspace)
8270 continue;
8271
8272 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
8273 {
8274 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
8275 return 1;
8276 }
8277 }
8278
8279 return 0;
8280 }
8281
8282 static void
8283 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
8284 {
8285 struct solib_catchpoint *self
8286 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8287 int ix;
8288
8289 if (self->is_load)
8290 {
8291 struct so_list *iter;
8292
8293 for (ix = 0;
8294 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
8295 ix, iter);
8296 ++ix)
8297 {
8298 if (!self->regex
8299 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8300 return;
8301 }
8302 }
8303 else
8304 {
8305 char *iter;
8306
8307 for (ix = 0;
8308 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
8309 ix, iter);
8310 ++ix)
8311 {
8312 if (!self->regex
8313 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8314 return;
8315 }
8316 }
8317
8318 bs->stop = 0;
8319 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8320 }
8321
8322 static enum print_stop_action
8323 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8324 {
8325 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8326 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8327
8328 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8329 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8330 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8331 else
8332 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8333 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8334 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
8335 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8336 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8337 print_solib_event (1);
8338 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8339 }
8340
8341 static void
8342 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8343 {
8344 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8345 struct value_print_options opts;
8346 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8347 char *msg;
8348
8349 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8350 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8351 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8352 readable). */
8353 if (opts.addressprint)
8354 {
8355 annotate_field (4);
8356 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8357 }
8358
8359 annotate_field (5);
8360 if (self->is_load)
8361 {
8362 if (self->regex)
8363 msg = xstrprintf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8364 else
8365 msg = xstrdup (_("load of library"));
8366 }
8367 else
8368 {
8369 if (self->regex)
8370 msg = xstrprintf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8371 else
8372 msg = xstrdup (_("unload of library"));
8373 }
8374 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
8375 xfree (msg);
8376
8377 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8378 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type",
8379 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8380 }
8381
8382 static void
8383 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8384 {
8385 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8386
8387 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8388 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8389 }
8390
8391 static void
8392 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8393 {
8394 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8395
8396 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8397 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8398 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8399 if (self->regex)
8400 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8401 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8402 }
8403
8404 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8405
8406 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8407 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8408 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8409 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8410 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8411 created in an enabled state. */
8412
8413 void
8414 add_solib_catchpoint (char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8415 {
8416 struct solib_catchpoint *c;
8417 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8418 struct cleanup *cleanup;
8419
8420 if (!arg)
8421 arg = "";
8422 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8423
8424 c = XCNEW (struct solib_catchpoint);
8425 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, c);
8426
8427 if (*arg != '\0')
8428 {
8429 int errcode;
8430
8431 errcode = regcomp (&c->compiled, arg, REG_NOSUB);
8432 if (errcode != 0)
8433 {
8434 char *err = get_regcomp_error (errcode, &c->compiled);
8435
8436 make_cleanup (xfree, err);
8437 error (_("Invalid regexp (%s): %s"), err, arg);
8438 }
8439 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8440 }
8441
8442 c->is_load = is_load;
8443 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8444 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8445
8446 c->base.enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8447
8448 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8449 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8450 }
8451
8452 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8453 "catch unload". */
8454
8455 static void
8456 catch_load_or_unload (char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8457 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8458 {
8459 int tempflag;
8460 const int enabled = 1;
8461
8462 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8463
8464 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8465 }
8466
8467 static void
8468 catch_load_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8469 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8470 {
8471 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8472 }
8473
8474 static void
8475 catch_unload_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8476 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8477 {
8478 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8479 }
8480
8481 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8482 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8483 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8484 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8485
8486 void
8487 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8488 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8489 char *cond_string,
8490 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8491 {
8492 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8493
8494 init_sal (&sal);
8495 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8496
8497 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8498
8499 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8500 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8501 }
8502
8503 void
8504 install_breakpoint (int internal, struct breakpoint *b, int update_gll)
8505 {
8506 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
8507 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8508 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8509 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8510 if (!internal)
8511 mention (b);
8512 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
8513
8514 if (update_gll)
8515 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8516 }
8517
8518 static void
8519 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8520 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
8521 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8522 {
8523 struct fork_catchpoint *c = XNEW (struct fork_catchpoint);
8524
8525 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8526
8527 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8528
8529 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8530 }
8531
8532 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8533
8534 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8535 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8536 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8537 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8538 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8539
8540 struct exec_catchpoint
8541 {
8542 /* The base class. */
8543 struct breakpoint base;
8544
8545 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8546 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8547 triggered. */
8548 char *exec_pathname;
8549 };
8550
8551 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8552 catchpoints. */
8553
8554 static void
8555 dtor_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8556 {
8557 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8558
8559 xfree (c->exec_pathname);
8560
8561 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8562 }
8563
8564 static int
8565 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8566 {
8567 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8568 }
8569
8570 static int
8571 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8572 {
8573 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8574 }
8575
8576 static int
8577 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8578 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8579 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8580 {
8581 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8582
8583 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8584 return 0;
8585
8586 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8587 return 1;
8588 }
8589
8590 static enum print_stop_action
8591 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8592 {
8593 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8594 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8595 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8596
8597 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8598 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8599 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8600 else
8601 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8602 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8603 {
8604 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8605 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8606 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8607 }
8608 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8609 ui_out_text (uiout, " (exec'd ");
8610 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8611 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8612
8613 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8614 }
8615
8616 static void
8617 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8618 {
8619 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8620 struct value_print_options opts;
8621 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8622
8623 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8624
8625 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8626 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8627 is relatively readable). */
8628 if (opts.addressprint)
8629 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8630 annotate_field (5);
8631 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
8632 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8633 {
8634 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
8635 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", c->exec_pathname);
8636 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
8637 }
8638
8639 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8640 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "exec");
8641 }
8642
8643 static void
8644 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8645 {
8646 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8647 }
8648
8649 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8650 catchpoints. */
8651
8652 static void
8653 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8654 {
8655 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8656 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8657 }
8658
8659 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8660
8661 static int
8662 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8663 {
8664 int i = 0;
8665 struct breakpoint *b;
8666 struct bp_location *bl;
8667
8668 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8669 {
8670 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8671 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8672 {
8673 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8674 one register. */
8675 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8676 }
8677 }
8678
8679 return i;
8680 }
8681
8682 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8683 watchpoint. */
8684
8685 static int
8686 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8687 {
8688 int i = 0;
8689 struct bp_location *bl;
8690
8691 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8692 return 0;
8693
8694 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8695 {
8696 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8697 one register. */
8698 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8699 }
8700
8701 return i;
8702 }
8703
8704 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8705 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8706 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8707 types _not_ TYPE. */
8708
8709 static int
8710 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8711 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8712 {
8713 int i = 0;
8714 struct breakpoint *b;
8715
8716 *other_type_used = 0;
8717 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8718 {
8719 if (b == except)
8720 continue;
8721 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8722 continue;
8723
8724 if (b->type == type)
8725 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8726 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8727 *other_type_used = 1;
8728 }
8729
8730 return i;
8731 }
8732
8733 void
8734 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8735 {
8736 struct breakpoint *b;
8737
8738 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8739 {
8740 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8741 {
8742 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8743 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8744 }
8745 }
8746 }
8747
8748 void
8749 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8750 {
8751 struct breakpoint *b;
8752
8753 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8754 {
8755 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8756 {
8757 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8758 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8759 }
8760 }
8761 }
8762
8763 void
8764 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8765 {
8766 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8767 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8768 }
8769
8770 void
8771 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8772 {
8773 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8774 breakpoint_re_set ();
8775 }
8776
8777 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8778 locations. */
8779
8780 static struct breakpoint *
8781 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8782 {
8783 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
8784
8785 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8786 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8787
8788 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8789 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8790
8791 b->thread = thread;
8792 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8793
8794 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
8795
8796 return b;
8797 }
8798
8799 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8800 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8801 frame. */
8802
8803 struct breakpoint *
8804 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8805 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8806 {
8807 struct breakpoint *b;
8808
8809 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8810 tail-called one. */
8811 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8812
8813 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8814 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8815 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8816 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8817
8818 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we want
8819 momentary breakpoints to be active in only a single thread of
8820 control. */
8821 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
8822 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
8823
8824 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8825
8826 return b;
8827 }
8828
8829 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8830 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8831 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8832
8833 static struct breakpoint *
8834 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8835 enum bptype type,
8836 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8837 int loc_enabled)
8838 {
8839 struct breakpoint *copy;
8840
8841 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8842 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8843 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
8844
8845 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8846 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8847 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8848 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8849 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8850 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8851 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8852 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8853 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8854 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8855 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8856 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8857
8858 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8859 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8860 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8861
8862 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8863 return copy;
8864 }
8865
8866 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8867 ORIG is NULL. */
8868
8869 struct breakpoint *
8870 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8871 {
8872 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8873 if (orig == NULL)
8874 return NULL;
8875
8876 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8877 }
8878
8879 struct breakpoint *
8880 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8881 enum bptype type)
8882 {
8883 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8884
8885 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8886 sal.pc = pc;
8887 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8888 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8889
8890 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8891 }
8892 \f
8893
8894 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8895
8896 static void
8897 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8898 {
8899 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8900 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
8901 return;
8902 printf_filtered ("\n");
8903 }
8904 \f
8905
8906 static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8907
8908 static struct bp_location *
8909 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8910 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8911 {
8912 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8913 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8914 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8915
8916 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8917 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8918
8919 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8920 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8921 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8922 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8923 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8924 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8925 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8926 sal->pc, b->type);
8927
8928 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8929 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8930 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8931 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8932 ;
8933 loc->next = *tmp;
8934 *tmp = loc;
8935
8936 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8937 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8938 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8939 loc->probe.probe = sal->probe;
8940 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8941 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8942 loc->section = sal->section;
8943 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8944 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8945 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8946
8947 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
8948 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
8949
8950 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8951 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8952 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8953 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8954 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8955 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8956 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8957 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8958 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8959 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8960 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8961 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8962 instruction.) */
8963 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8964 loc->permanent = 1;
8965
8966 return loc;
8967 }
8968 \f
8969
8970 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8971
8972 int
8973 program_breakpoint_here_p (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
8974 {
8975 int len;
8976 CORE_ADDR addr;
8977 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
8978 gdb_byte *target_mem;
8979 struct cleanup *cleanup;
8980 int retval = 0;
8981
8982 addr = address;
8983 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &len);
8984
8985 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
8986 if (bpoint == NULL)
8987 return 0;
8988
8989 target_mem = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
8990
8991 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
8992 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
8993 breakpoints they are permanent. */
8994 cleanup = make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
8995
8996 if (target_read_memory (address, target_mem, len) == 0
8997 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
8998 retval = 1;
8999
9000 do_cleanups (cleanup);
9001
9002 return retval;
9003 }
9004
9005 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
9006 return 0 otherwise. */
9007
9008 static int
9009 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
9010 {
9011 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9012 int retval;
9013
9014 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
9015
9016 /* If we have a catchpoint or a watchpoint, just return 0. We should not
9017 attempt to read from the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types
9018 point to. program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
9019 memory. */
9020 if (!breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (loc->owner))
9021 return 0;
9022
9023 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
9024 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
9025
9026 retval = program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
9027
9028 do_cleanups (cleanup);
9029
9030 return retval;
9031 }
9032
9033 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
9034 settings of the dprintf style options. */
9035
9036 static void
9037 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
9038 {
9039 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
9040 char *printf_line = NULL;
9041
9042 if (!dprintf_args)
9043 return;
9044
9045 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
9046
9047 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
9048 insist on it. */
9049 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
9050 ++dprintf_args;
9051 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
9052
9053 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
9054 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
9055
9056 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
9057 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
9058 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
9059 {
9060 if (!dprintf_function)
9061 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
9062
9063 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
9064 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
9065 dprintf_function,
9066 dprintf_channel,
9067 dprintf_args);
9068 else
9069 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
9070 dprintf_function,
9071 dprintf_args);
9072 }
9073 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
9074 {
9075 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
9076 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
9077 else
9078 {
9079 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
9080 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
9081 }
9082 }
9083 else
9084 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9085 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
9086
9087 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
9088 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
9089 {
9090 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line = XNEW (struct command_line);
9091
9092 printf_cmd_line->control_type = simple_control;
9093 printf_cmd_line->body_count = 0;
9094 printf_cmd_line->body_list = NULL;
9095 printf_cmd_line->next = NULL;
9096 printf_cmd_line->line = printf_line;
9097
9098 breakpoint_set_commands (b, printf_cmd_line);
9099 }
9100 }
9101
9102 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
9103 current style settings. */
9104
9105 static void
9106 update_dprintf_commands (char *args, int from_tty,
9107 struct cmd_list_element *c)
9108 {
9109 struct breakpoint *b;
9110
9111 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9112 {
9113 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
9114 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9115 }
9116 }
9117
9118 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
9119 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
9120 as condition expression. */
9121
9122 static void
9123 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9124 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
9125 struct event_location *location,
9126 char *filter, char *cond_string,
9127 char *extra_string,
9128 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9129 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9130 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9131 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9132 int display_canonical)
9133 {
9134 int i;
9135
9136 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9137 {
9138 int target_resources_ok;
9139
9140 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9141 target_resources_ok =
9142 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9143 i + 1, 0);
9144 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9145 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9146 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9147 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9148 }
9149
9150 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
9151
9152 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
9153 {
9154 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
9155 struct bp_location *loc;
9156
9157 if (from_tty)
9158 {
9159 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9160 if (!loc_gdbarch)
9161 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
9162
9163 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
9164 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
9165 }
9166
9167 if (i == 0)
9168 {
9169 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
9170 b->thread = thread;
9171 b->task = task;
9172
9173 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9174 b->extra_string = extra_string;
9175 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9176 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9177 b->disposition = disposition;
9178
9179 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
9180 b->loc->inserted = 1;
9181
9182 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
9183 {
9184 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
9185 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
9186
9187 if (strace_marker_p (b))
9188 {
9189 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
9190 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
9191 const char *p = &event_location_to_string (b->location)[3];
9192 const char *endp;
9193 char *marker_str;
9194
9195 p = skip_spaces_const (p);
9196
9197 endp = skip_to_space_const (p);
9198
9199 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9200 t->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str;
9201
9202 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
9203 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
9204 t->static_trace_marker_id);
9205 }
9206 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
9207 {
9208 t->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
9209 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
9210
9211 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
9212 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
9213 t->static_trace_marker_id);
9214 }
9215 else
9216 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
9217 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
9218 }
9219
9220 loc = b->loc;
9221 }
9222 else
9223 {
9224 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
9225 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
9226 loc->inserted = 1;
9227 }
9228
9229 if (b->cond_string)
9230 {
9231 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
9232
9233 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
9234 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
9235 if (*arg)
9236 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
9237 }
9238
9239 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
9240 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
9241 if (type == bp_dprintf)
9242 {
9243 if (b->extra_string)
9244 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9245 else
9246 error (_("Format string required"));
9247 }
9248 else if (b->extra_string)
9249 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
9250 }
9251
9252 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
9253 if (location != NULL)
9254 b->location = location;
9255 else
9256 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address);
9257 b->filter = filter;
9258 }
9259
9260 static void
9261 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9262 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
9263 struct event_location *location,
9264 char *filter, char *cond_string,
9265 char *extra_string,
9266 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9267 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9268 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9269 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9270 int display_canonical)
9271 {
9272 struct breakpoint *b;
9273 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9274
9275 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
9276 {
9277 struct tracepoint *t;
9278
9279 t = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
9280 b = &t->base;
9281 }
9282 else
9283 b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
9284
9285 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, b);
9286
9287 init_breakpoint_sal (b, gdbarch,
9288 sals, location,
9289 filter, cond_string, extra_string,
9290 type, disposition,
9291 thread, task, ignore_count,
9292 ops, from_tty,
9293 enabled, internal, flags,
9294 display_canonical);
9295 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
9296
9297 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
9298 }
9299
9300 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
9301 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
9302 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
9303 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
9304 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
9305 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
9306 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
9307 we take just a single condition string.
9308
9309 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
9310 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
9311 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
9312 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
9313 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
9314
9315 static void
9316 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9317 struct linespec_result *canonical,
9318 char *cond_string, char *extra_string,
9319 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9320 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9321 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9322 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
9323 {
9324 int i;
9325 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
9326
9327 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
9328 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical->sals) == 1);
9329
9330 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, i, lsal); ++i)
9331 {
9332 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
9333 'break', without arguments. */
9334 struct event_location *location
9335 = (canonical->location != NULL
9336 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location) : NULL);
9337 char *filter_string = lsal->canonical ? xstrdup (lsal->canonical) : NULL;
9338 struct cleanup *inner = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
9339
9340 make_cleanup (xfree, filter_string);
9341 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal->sals,
9342 location,
9343 filter_string,
9344 cond_string, extra_string,
9345 type, disposition,
9346 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9347 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
9348 canonical->special_display);
9349 discard_cleanups (inner);
9350 }
9351 }
9352
9353 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
9354 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
9355 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
9356 linespec locations).
9357
9358 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
9359 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
9360
9361 static void
9362 parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
9363 struct linespec_result *canonical)
9364 {
9365 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
9366
9367 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9368 {
9369 const char *address = get_linespec_location (location);
9370
9371 if (address == NULL)
9372 {
9373 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
9374 breakpoint address. */
9375 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9376 {
9377 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9378 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9379 CORE_ADDR pc;
9380
9381 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
9382 lsal.sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line);
9383
9384 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9385 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9386 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9387 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9388 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9389 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
9390 pc = sal.pc;
9391 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9392
9393 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9394 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9395 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9396 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9397 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9398 sal.pc = pc;
9399 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9400
9401 lsal.sals.sals[0] = sal;
9402 lsal.sals.nelts = 1;
9403 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9404
9405 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
9406 return;
9407 }
9408 else
9409 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9410 }
9411 }
9412
9413 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9414 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9415 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9416 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9417
9418 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9419 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9420 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9421 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9422 {
9423 const char *address = NULL;
9424
9425 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9426 address = get_linespec_location (location);
9427
9428 if (!cursal.symtab
9429 || (address != NULL
9430 && strchr ("+-", address[0]) != NULL
9431 && address[1] != '['))
9432 {
9433 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
9434 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9435 get_last_displayed_line (),
9436 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9437 return;
9438 }
9439 }
9440
9441 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
9442 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9443 }
9444
9445
9446 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9447 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9448
9449 static void
9450 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
9451 {
9452 int i;
9453
9454 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
9455 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
9456 }
9457
9458 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9459 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9460 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9461 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9462 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9463 it, etc. */
9464
9465 static void
9466 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9467 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
9468 {
9469 int i, rslt;
9470 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
9471 char *msg;
9472 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9473
9474 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
9475 {
9476 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9477
9478 sal = &sals->sals[i];
9479
9480 sarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
9481 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9482 associated with SAL. */
9483 if (sarch == NULL)
9484 sarch = gdbarch;
9485 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal->pc, &msg);
9486 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
9487
9488 if (!rslt)
9489 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
9490 paddress (sarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
9491
9492 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9493 }
9494 }
9495
9496 /* Issue an invalid thread ID error. */
9497
9498 static void ATTRIBUTE_NORETURN
9499 invalid_thread_id_error (int id)
9500 {
9501 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), id);
9502 }
9503
9504 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9505 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9506 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9507 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9508 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9509 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9510
9511 static void
9512 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9513 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9514 char **rest)
9515 {
9516 *cond_string = NULL;
9517 *thread = -1;
9518 *task = 0;
9519 *rest = NULL;
9520
9521 while (tok && *tok)
9522 {
9523 const char *end_tok;
9524 int toklen;
9525 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9526 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9527
9528 tok = skip_spaces_const (tok);
9529
9530 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9531 {
9532 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9533 return;
9534 }
9535
9536 end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok);
9537
9538 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9539
9540 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9541 {
9542 struct expression *expr;
9543
9544 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9545 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9546 xfree (expr);
9547 cond_end = tok;
9548 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9549 }
9550 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9551 {
9552 char *tmptok;
9553
9554 tok = end_tok + 1;
9555 *thread = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9556 if (tok == tmptok)
9557 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9558 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
9559 invalid_thread_id_error (*thread);
9560 tok = tmptok;
9561 }
9562 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9563 {
9564 char *tmptok;
9565
9566 tok = end_tok + 1;
9567 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9568 if (tok == tmptok)
9569 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9570 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9571 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9572 tok = tmptok;
9573 }
9574 else if (rest)
9575 {
9576 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9577 return;
9578 }
9579 else
9580 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9581 }
9582 }
9583
9584 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9585
9586 static struct symtabs_and_lines
9587 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9588 {
9589 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL;
9590 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9591 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9592 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9593 const char *endp;
9594 char *marker_str;
9595 int i;
9596
9597 p = skip_spaces_const (p);
9598
9599 endp = skip_to_space_const (p);
9600
9601 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9602 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, marker_str);
9603
9604 markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str);
9605 if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
9606 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), marker_str);
9607
9608 sals.nelts = VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers);
9609 sals.sals = XNEWVEC (struct symtab_and_line, sals.nelts);
9610
9611 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
9612 {
9613 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
9614
9615 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i);
9616
9617 init_sal (&sals.sals[i]);
9618
9619 sals.sals[i] = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
9620 sals.sals[i].pc = marker->address;
9621
9622 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
9623 }
9624
9625 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9626
9627 *arg_p = endp;
9628 return sals;
9629 }
9630
9631 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9632
9633 int
9634 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9635 const struct event_location *location, char *cond_string,
9636 int thread, char *extra_string,
9637 int parse_extra,
9638 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9639 int ignore_count,
9640 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9641 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9642 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9643 unsigned flags)
9644 {
9645 struct linespec_result canonical;
9646 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9647 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
9648 int pending = 0;
9649 int task = 0;
9650 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9651
9652 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9653
9654 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9655 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9656 extra_string = NULL;
9657
9658 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
9659
9660 TRY
9661 {
9662 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9663 }
9664 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9665 {
9666 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9667 value. */
9668 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9669 {
9670 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9671 error. */
9672
9673 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9674 throw_exception (e);
9675
9676 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9677
9678 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9679 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9680 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9681 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9682 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9683 return 0;
9684
9685 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9686 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9687 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9688 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9689 pending = 1;
9690 }
9691 else
9692 throw_exception (e);
9693 }
9694 END_CATCH
9695
9696 if (!pending && VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical.sals))
9697 return 0;
9698
9699 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
9700 old_chain = make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
9701
9702 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
9703 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
9704 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
9705 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
9706 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
9707
9708 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9709 are ok for the target. */
9710 if (!pending)
9711 {
9712 int ix;
9713 struct linespec_sals *iter;
9714
9715 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
9716 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&iter->sals);
9717 }
9718
9719 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9720 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9721 {
9722 int ix;
9723 struct linespec_sals *iter;
9724
9725 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
9726 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &iter->sals);
9727 }
9728
9729 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9730 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9731 breakpoint. */
9732 if (!pending)
9733 {
9734 if (parse_extra)
9735 {
9736 char *rest;
9737 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
9738
9739 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
9740
9741 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9742 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9743 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9744 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9745
9746 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal->sals.sals[0].pc,
9747 &cond_string, &thread, &task, &rest);
9748 if (cond_string)
9749 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9750 if (rest)
9751 make_cleanup (xfree, rest);
9752 if (rest)
9753 extra_string = rest;
9754 else
9755 extra_string = NULL;
9756 }
9757 else
9758 {
9759 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9760 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9761 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9762
9763 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9764 if (cond_string)
9765 {
9766 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
9767 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9768 }
9769 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9770 if (extra_string)
9771 {
9772 extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string);
9773 make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string);
9774 }
9775 }
9776
9777 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9778 cond_string, extra_string, type_wanted,
9779 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9780 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9781 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9782 }
9783 else
9784 {
9785 struct breakpoint *b;
9786
9787 if (is_tracepoint_type (type_wanted))
9788 {
9789 struct tracepoint *t;
9790
9791 t = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
9792 b = &t->base;
9793 }
9794 else
9795 b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
9796
9797 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9798 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9799
9800 if (parse_extra)
9801 b->cond_string = NULL;
9802 else
9803 {
9804 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9805 if (cond_string)
9806 {
9807 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
9808 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
9809 }
9810 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9811 b->thread = thread;
9812 }
9813
9814 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9815 if (extra_string != NULL)
9816 {
9817 extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string);
9818 make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string);
9819 }
9820 b->extra_string = extra_string;
9821 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9822 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9823 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9824 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9825 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9826 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9827 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9828
9829 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
9830 }
9831
9832 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 1)
9833 {
9834 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9835 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9836 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9837 }
9838
9839 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
9840 breakpoint. */
9841 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
9842 /* But cleanup everything else. */
9843 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9844
9845 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
9846 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9847
9848 return 1;
9849 }
9850
9851 /* Set a breakpoint.
9852 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9853 condition, and thread.
9854 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9855 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9856 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9857
9858 static void
9859 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9860 {
9861 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9862 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9863 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9864 : bp_breakpoint);
9865 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
9866 struct event_location *location;
9867 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9868
9869 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9870 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
9871
9872 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
9873 if (location != NULL
9874 && event_location_type (location) == PROBE_LOCATION)
9875 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9876 else
9877 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9878
9879 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9880 location,
9881 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9882 tempflag, type_wanted,
9883 0 /* Ignore count */,
9884 pending_break_support,
9885 ops,
9886 from_tty,
9887 1 /* enabled */,
9888 0 /* internal */,
9889 0);
9890 do_cleanups (cleanup);
9891 }
9892
9893 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9894
9895 void
9896 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9897 {
9898 CORE_ADDR pc;
9899
9900 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9901 {
9902 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9903 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9904 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9905 sal->pc = pc;
9906
9907 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9908 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9909 if (sal->explicit_line)
9910 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9911 }
9912
9913 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9914 {
9915 const struct blockvector *bv;
9916 const struct block *b;
9917 struct symbol *sym;
9918
9919 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9920 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
9921 if (bv != NULL)
9922 {
9923 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9924 if (sym != NULL)
9925 {
9926 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9927 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
9928 sym);
9929 }
9930 else
9931 {
9932 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9933 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9934 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9935 happen in assembly source). */
9936
9937 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym;
9938 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
9939
9940 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9941
9942 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9943 if (msym.minsym)
9944 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
9945
9946 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9947 }
9948 }
9949 }
9950 }
9951
9952 void
9953 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9954 {
9955 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9956 }
9957
9958 void
9959 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9960 {
9961 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9962 }
9963
9964 static void
9965 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9966 {
9967 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9968 }
9969
9970 static void
9971 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9972 {
9973 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9974 }
9975
9976 static void
9977 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9978 {
9979 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9980 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9981 stop at <line>\n"));
9982 }
9983
9984 static void
9985 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9986 {
9987 int badInput = 0;
9988
9989 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
9990 badInput = 1;
9991 else if (*arg != '*')
9992 {
9993 char *argptr = arg;
9994 int hasColon = 0;
9995
9996 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9997 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9998 function/method name. */
9999 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
10000 {
10001 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
10002 argptr++;
10003 }
10004
10005 if (hasColon)
10006 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
10007 else
10008 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
10009 }
10010
10011 if (badInput)
10012 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
10013 else
10014 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10015 }
10016
10017 static void
10018 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10019 {
10020 int badInput = 0;
10021
10022 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
10023 badInput = 1;
10024 else
10025 {
10026 char *argptr = arg;
10027 int hasColon = 0;
10028
10029 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
10030 it is probably a line number. */
10031 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
10032 {
10033 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
10034 argptr++;
10035 }
10036
10037 if (hasColon)
10038 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
10039 else
10040 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
10041 }
10042
10043 if (badInput)
10044 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
10045 else
10046 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10047 }
10048
10049 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
10050 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
10051 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
10052 line. */
10053
10054 static void
10055 dprintf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10056 {
10057 struct event_location *location;
10058 struct cleanup *cleanup;
10059
10060 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10061 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
10062
10063 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
10064 the next character must be ','. */
10065 if (arg != NULL)
10066 {
10067 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
10068 error (_("Format string required"));
10069 else
10070 {
10071 /* Skip the comma. */
10072 ++arg;
10073 }
10074 }
10075
10076 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10077 location,
10078 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
10079 0, bp_dprintf,
10080 0 /* Ignore count */,
10081 pending_break_support,
10082 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
10083 from_tty,
10084 1 /* enabled */,
10085 0 /* internal */,
10086 0);
10087 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10088 }
10089
10090 static void
10091 agent_printf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10092 {
10093 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
10094 }
10095
10096 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
10097 ranged breakpoints. */
10098
10099 static int
10100 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10101 struct address_space *aspace,
10102 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10103 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10104 {
10105 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
10106 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10107 return 0;
10108
10109 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
10110 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
10111 }
10112
10113 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10114 ranged breakpoints. */
10115
10116 static int
10117 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10118 {
10119 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
10120 }
10121
10122 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10123 ranged breakpoints. */
10124
10125 static enum print_stop_action
10126 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
10127 {
10128 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10129 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10130 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10131
10132 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
10133
10134 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
10135 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
10136
10137 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
10138 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
10139 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary ranged breakpoint ");
10140 else
10141 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nRanged breakpoint ");
10142 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10143 {
10144 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
10145 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
10146 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
10147 }
10148 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
10149 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
10150
10151 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
10152 }
10153
10154 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
10155 ranged breakpoints. */
10156
10157 static void
10158 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
10159 struct bp_location **last_loc)
10160 {
10161 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10162 struct value_print_options opts;
10163 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10164
10165 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
10166 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
10167
10168 get_user_print_options (&opts);
10169
10170 if (opts.addressprint)
10171 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
10172 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
10173 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
10174 annotate_field (5);
10175 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
10176 *last_loc = bl;
10177 }
10178
10179 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10180 ranged breakpoints. */
10181
10182 static void
10183 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10184 struct ui_out *uiout)
10185 {
10186 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
10187 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10188 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
10189 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10190
10191 gdb_assert (bl);
10192
10193 address_start = bl->address;
10194 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
10195
10196 ui_out_text (uiout, "\taddress range: ");
10197 fprintf_unfiltered (stb, "[%s, %s]",
10198 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
10199 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
10200 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "addr", stb);
10201 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10202
10203 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10204 }
10205
10206 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10207 ranged breakpoints. */
10208
10209 static void
10210 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10211 {
10212 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10213 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10214
10215 gdb_assert (bl);
10216 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
10217
10218 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10219 return;
10220
10221 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
10222 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
10223 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
10224 }
10225
10226 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10227 ranged breakpoints. */
10228
10229 static void
10230 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10231 {
10232 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
10233 event_location_to_string (b->location),
10234 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end));
10235 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10236 }
10237
10238 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
10239
10240 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
10241
10242 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
10243 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
10244 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
10245 last instruction of the given line. */
10246
10247 static CORE_ADDR
10248 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
10249 {
10250 CORE_ADDR end;
10251
10252 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
10253 find the address of the end of the given location. */
10254 if (sal.explicit_pc)
10255 end = sal.pc;
10256 else
10257 {
10258 int ret;
10259 CORE_ADDR start;
10260
10261 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
10262 if (!ret)
10263 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10264
10265 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
10266 end--;
10267 }
10268
10269 return end;
10270 }
10271
10272 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
10273
10274 static void
10275 break_range_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10276 {
10277 char *arg_start, *addr_string_start, *addr_string_end;
10278 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
10279 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
10280 CORE_ADDR end;
10281 struct breakpoint *b;
10282 struct symtab_and_line sal_start, sal_end;
10283 struct cleanup *cleanup_bkpt;
10284 struct linespec_sals *lsal_start, *lsal_end;
10285 struct event_location *start_location, *end_location;
10286
10287 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
10288 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
10289 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
10290
10291 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
10292 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
10293 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
10294 bp_count, 0);
10295 if (can_use_bp < 0)
10296 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
10297
10298 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10299 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
10300 error(_("No address range specified."));
10301
10302 init_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
10303
10304 arg_start = arg;
10305 start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10306 cleanup_bkpt = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (start_location);
10307 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location, &canonical_start);
10308 make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
10309
10310 if (arg[0] != ',')
10311 error (_("Too few arguments."));
10312 else if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals))
10313 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
10314
10315 lsal_start = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals, 0);
10316
10317 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals) > 1
10318 || lsal_start->sals.nelts != 1)
10319 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10320
10321 sal_start = lsal_start->sals.sals[0];
10322 addr_string_start = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
10323 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string_start);
10324
10325 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
10326 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10327
10328 /* Parse the end location. */
10329
10330 init_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
10331 arg_start = arg;
10332
10333 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
10334 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
10335 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
10336 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
10337 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
10338 end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
10339 make_cleanup_delete_event_location (end_location);
10340 decode_line_full (end_location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
10341 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
10342 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
10343
10344 make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
10345
10346 if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals))
10347 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10348
10349 lsal_end = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals, 0);
10350 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals) > 1
10351 || lsal_end->sals.nelts != 1)
10352 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10353
10354 sal_end = lsal_end->sals.sals[0];
10355
10356 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
10357 if (sal_start.pc > end)
10358 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
10359
10360 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
10361 if (length < 0)
10362 /* Length overflowed. */
10363 error (_("Address range too large."));
10364 else if (length == 1)
10365 {
10366 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
10367 the `hbreak' command. */
10368 hbreak_command (addr_string_start, 1);
10369
10370 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
10371
10372 return;
10373 }
10374
10375 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
10376 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
10377 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
10378 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
10379 b->number = breakpoint_count;
10380 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10381 b->location = copy_event_location (start_location);
10382 b->location_range_end = copy_event_location (end_location);
10383 b->loc->length = length;
10384
10385 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
10386
10387 mention (b);
10388 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
10389 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
10390 }
10391
10392 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
10393 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
10394 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
10395 zero. */
10396
10397 static int
10398 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
10399 {
10400 int i = exp->nelts;
10401
10402 while (i > 0)
10403 {
10404 int oplenp, argsp;
10405
10406 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
10407 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
10408 i -= oplenp;
10409
10410 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
10411 {
10412 case BINOP_ADD:
10413 case BINOP_SUB:
10414 case BINOP_MUL:
10415 case BINOP_DIV:
10416 case BINOP_REM:
10417 case BINOP_MOD:
10418 case BINOP_LSH:
10419 case BINOP_RSH:
10420 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
10421 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
10422 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
10423 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
10424 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
10425 case BINOP_EQUAL:
10426 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
10427 case BINOP_LESS:
10428 case BINOP_GTR:
10429 case BINOP_LEQ:
10430 case BINOP_GEQ:
10431 case BINOP_REPEAT:
10432 case BINOP_COMMA:
10433 case BINOP_EXP:
10434 case BINOP_MIN:
10435 case BINOP_MAX:
10436 case BINOP_INTDIV:
10437 case BINOP_CONCAT:
10438 case TERNOP_COND:
10439 case TERNOP_SLICE:
10440
10441 case OP_LONG:
10442 case OP_DOUBLE:
10443 case OP_DECFLOAT:
10444 case OP_LAST:
10445 case OP_COMPLEX:
10446 case OP_STRING:
10447 case OP_ARRAY:
10448 case OP_TYPE:
10449 case OP_TYPEOF:
10450 case OP_DECLTYPE:
10451 case OP_TYPEID:
10452 case OP_NAME:
10453 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
10454
10455 case UNOP_NEG:
10456 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
10457 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
10458 case UNOP_ADDR:
10459 case UNOP_HIGH:
10460 case UNOP_CAST:
10461
10462 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
10463 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
10464 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
10465 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
10466 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
10467 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
10468 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
10469
10470 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
10471 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
10472 ADDR is. */
10473 break;
10474
10475 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10476 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
10477
10478 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
10479 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
10480 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
10481 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
10482
10483 We also have to check for function symbols because they
10484 are always constant. */
10485 {
10486 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
10487
10488 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
10489 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
10490 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
10491 return 0;
10492 break;
10493 }
10494
10495 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
10496 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
10497 then it is not a constant. */
10498 default:
10499 return 0;
10500 }
10501 }
10502
10503 return 1;
10504 }
10505
10506 /* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10507
10508 static void
10509 dtor_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *self)
10510 {
10511 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) self;
10512
10513 xfree (w->cond_exp);
10514 xfree (w->exp);
10515 xfree (w->exp_string);
10516 xfree (w->exp_string_reparse);
10517 value_free (w->val);
10518
10519 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
10520 }
10521
10522 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10523
10524 static void
10525 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10526 {
10527 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10528
10529 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10530 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10531
10532 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10533 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10534 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10535 are loaded and unloaded.
10536
10537 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10538 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10539 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10540 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10541 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10542 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10543
10544 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10545 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10546 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10547 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10548
10549 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10550 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10551
10552 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10553 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10554 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10555 }
10556
10557 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10558
10559 static int
10560 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10561 {
10562 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10563 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10564
10565 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10566 w->cond_exp);
10567 }
10568
10569 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10570
10571 static int
10572 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10573 {
10574 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10575 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10576
10577 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10578 w->cond_exp);
10579 }
10580
10581 static int
10582 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10583 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10584 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10585 {
10586 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10587 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10588
10589 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10590 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10591 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10592 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10593 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10594 (did not match the data address). */
10595 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10596 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10597 return 0;
10598
10599 return 1;
10600 }
10601
10602 static void
10603 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10604 {
10605 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10606
10607 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10608 }
10609
10610 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10611 hardware watchpoints. */
10612
10613 static int
10614 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10615 {
10616 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10617 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10618
10619 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10620 }
10621
10622 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10623 hardware watchpoints. */
10624
10625 static int
10626 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10627 {
10628 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10629 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10630 }
10631
10632 static enum print_stop_action
10633 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10634 {
10635 struct cleanup *old_chain;
10636 struct breakpoint *b;
10637 struct ui_file *stb;
10638 enum print_stop_action result;
10639 struct watchpoint *w;
10640 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10641
10642 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10643
10644 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10645 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10646
10647 stb = mem_fileopen ();
10648 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10649
10650 switch (b->type)
10651 {
10652 case bp_watchpoint:
10653 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10654 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10655 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10656 ui_out_field_string
10657 (uiout, "reason",
10658 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10659 mention (b);
10660 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10661 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10662 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10663 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10664 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10665 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10666 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10667 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10668 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10669 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10670 break;
10671
10672 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10673 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10674 ui_out_field_string
10675 (uiout, "reason",
10676 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10677 mention (b);
10678 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10679 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10680 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10681 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
10682 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10683 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10684 break;
10685
10686 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10687 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10688 {
10689 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10690 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10691 ui_out_field_string
10692 (uiout, "reason",
10693 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10694 mention (b);
10695 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10696 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10697 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10698 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10699 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10700 }
10701 else
10702 {
10703 mention (b);
10704 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10705 ui_out_field_string
10706 (uiout, "reason",
10707 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10708 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10709 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10710 }
10711 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10712 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10713 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10714 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10715 break;
10716 default:
10717 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10718 }
10719
10720 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10721 return result;
10722 }
10723
10724 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10725 watchpoints. */
10726
10727 static void
10728 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10729 {
10730 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
10731 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10732 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10733
10734 switch (b->type)
10735 {
10736 case bp_watchpoint:
10737 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
10738 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10739 break;
10740 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10741 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
10742 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10743 break;
10744 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10745 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
10746 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
10747 break;
10748 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10749 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10750 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
10751 break;
10752 default:
10753 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10754 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10755 }
10756
10757 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
10758 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
10759 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
10760 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
10761 }
10762
10763 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10764 watchpoints. */
10765
10766 static void
10767 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10768 {
10769 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10770
10771 switch (b->type)
10772 {
10773 case bp_watchpoint:
10774 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10775 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10776 break;
10777 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10778 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10779 break;
10780 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10781 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10782 break;
10783 default:
10784 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10785 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10786 }
10787
10788 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10789 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10790 }
10791
10792 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10793 watchpoints. */
10794
10795 static int
10796 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10797 {
10798 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10799 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10800 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10801 return 0;
10802
10803 return 1;
10804 }
10805
10806 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10807
10808 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10809
10810 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10811 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10812
10813 static int
10814 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10815 {
10816 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10817
10818 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10819 bl->watchpoint_type);
10820 }
10821
10822 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10823 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10824
10825 static int
10826 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10827 {
10828 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10829
10830 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10831 bl->watchpoint_type);
10832 }
10833
10834 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10835 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10836
10837 static int
10838 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10839 {
10840 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10841
10842 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10843 }
10844
10845 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10846 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10847
10848 static int
10849 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10850 {
10851 return 0;
10852 }
10853
10854 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10855 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10856
10857 static enum print_stop_action
10858 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10859 {
10860 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10861 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10862
10863 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10864 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10865
10866 switch (b->type)
10867 {
10868 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10869 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10870 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10871 ui_out_field_string
10872 (uiout, "reason",
10873 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10874 break;
10875
10876 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10877 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10878 ui_out_field_string
10879 (uiout, "reason",
10880 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10881 break;
10882
10883 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10884 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10885 ui_out_field_string
10886 (uiout, "reason",
10887 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10888 break;
10889 default:
10890 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10891 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10892 }
10893
10894 mention (b);
10895 ui_out_text (uiout, _("\n\
10896 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10897 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10898 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10899
10900 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10901 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10902 }
10903
10904 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10905 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10906
10907 static void
10908 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10909 struct ui_out *uiout)
10910 {
10911 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10912
10913 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10914 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10915
10916 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmask ");
10917 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10918 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10919 }
10920
10921 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10922 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10923
10924 static void
10925 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10926 {
10927 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10928 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10929 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
10930
10931 switch (b->type)
10932 {
10933 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10934 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10935 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
10936 break;
10937 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10938 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10939 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
10940 break;
10941 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10942 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10943 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
10944 break;
10945 default:
10946 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10947 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10948 }
10949
10950 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
10951 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
10952 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
10953 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
10954 }
10955
10956 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10957 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10958
10959 static void
10960 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10961 {
10962 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10963 char tmp[40];
10964
10965 switch (b->type)
10966 {
10967 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10968 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10969 break;
10970 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10971 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10972 break;
10973 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10974 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10975 break;
10976 default:
10977 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10978 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10979 }
10980
10981 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
10982 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
10983 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10984 }
10985
10986 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10987
10988 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10989
10990 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10991
10992 static int
10993 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10994 {
10995 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10996 }
10997
10998 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10999 hw_read: watch read,
11000 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
11001 static void
11002 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
11003 int just_location, int internal)
11004 {
11005 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
11006 struct expression *exp;
11007 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
11008 struct value *val, *mark, *result;
11009 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
11010 struct frame_info *frame;
11011 const char *exp_start = NULL;
11012 const char *exp_end = NULL;
11013 const char *tok, *end_tok;
11014 int toklen = -1;
11015 const char *cond_start = NULL;
11016 const char *cond_end = NULL;
11017 enum bptype bp_type;
11018 int thread = -1;
11019 int pc = 0;
11020 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
11021 the hardware watchpoint. */
11022 int use_mask = 0;
11023 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
11024 struct watchpoint *w;
11025 char *expression;
11026 struct cleanup *back_to;
11027
11028 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
11029 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
11030 {
11031 const char *value_start;
11032
11033 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
11034
11035 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
11036 of the arguments string. */
11037 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
11038 {
11039 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
11040 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
11041 tok--;
11042
11043 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
11044 This is the value of the parameter. */
11045 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
11046 tok--;
11047 value_start = tok + 1;
11048
11049 /* Skip whitespace. */
11050 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
11051 tok--;
11052
11053 end_tok = tok;
11054
11055 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
11056 This is the parameter itself. */
11057 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
11058 tok--;
11059 tok++;
11060 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
11061
11062 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
11063 {
11064 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
11065 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
11066 only in a specific thread. */
11067 char *endp;
11068
11069 if (thread != -1)
11070 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
11071
11072 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
11073 thread = strtol (value_start, &endp, 0);
11074
11075 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
11076 thread ID. */
11077 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
11078 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), value_start);
11079
11080 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
11081 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
11082 invalid_thread_id_error (thread);
11083 }
11084 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
11085 {
11086 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
11087 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
11088 facility. */
11089 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
11090
11091 if (use_mask)
11092 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
11093
11094 use_mask = just_location = 1;
11095
11096 mark = value_mark ();
11097 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
11098 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
11099 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11100 }
11101 else
11102 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
11103 break;
11104
11105 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
11106 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
11107 exp_end = tok;
11108 }
11109 }
11110 else
11111 exp_end = arg;
11112
11113 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
11114 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
11115 ARG. */
11116 innermost_block = NULL;
11117 expression = savestring (arg, exp_end - arg);
11118 back_to = make_cleanup (xfree, expression);
11119 exp_start = arg = expression;
11120 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
11121 exp_end = arg;
11122 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
11123 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
11124 prettier. */
11125 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
11126 --exp_end;
11127
11128 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
11129 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp))
11130 {
11131 int len;
11132
11133 len = exp_end - exp_start;
11134 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
11135 len--;
11136 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
11137 }
11138
11139 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
11140 mark = value_mark ();
11141 fetch_subexp_value (exp, &pc, &val, &result, NULL, just_location);
11142
11143 if (val != NULL && just_location)
11144 {
11145 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val);
11146 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val);
11147 }
11148
11149 if (just_location)
11150 {
11151 int ret;
11152
11153 exp_valid_block = NULL;
11154 val = value_addr (result);
11155 release_value (val);
11156 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11157
11158 if (use_mask)
11159 {
11160 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val),
11161 mask);
11162 if (ret == -1)
11163 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
11164 else if (ret == -2)
11165 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
11166 }
11167 }
11168 else if (val != NULL)
11169 release_value (val);
11170
11171 tok = skip_spaces_const (arg);
11172 end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok);
11173
11174 toklen = end_tok - tok;
11175 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
11176 {
11177 struct expression *cond;
11178
11179 innermost_block = NULL;
11180 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
11181 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
11182
11183 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
11184 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
11185 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
11186
11187 xfree (cond);
11188 cond_end = tok;
11189 }
11190 if (*tok)
11191 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
11192
11193 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
11194
11195 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
11196 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
11197 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
11198 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
11199 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
11200 {
11201 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
11202 {
11203 scope_breakpoint
11204 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
11205 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
11206 bp_watchpoint_scope,
11207 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
11208
11209 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
11210
11211 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
11212 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
11213
11214 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
11215 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11216
11217 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
11218 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
11219 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11220 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
11221 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11222 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
11223 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
11224 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
11225 scope_breakpoint->type);
11226 }
11227 }
11228
11229 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
11230 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
11231 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
11232 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
11233
11234 if (accessflag == hw_read)
11235 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
11236 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
11237 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
11238 else
11239 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
11240
11241 w = XCNEW (struct watchpoint);
11242 b = &w->base;
11243 if (use_mask)
11244 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
11245 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
11246 else
11247 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
11248 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
11249 b->thread = thread;
11250 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
11251 b->pspace = current_program_space;
11252 w->exp = exp;
11253 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
11254 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
11255 if (just_location)
11256 {
11257 struct type *t = value_type (val);
11258 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val);
11259 char *name;
11260
11261 t = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (t)));
11262 name = type_to_string (t);
11263
11264 w->exp_string_reparse = xstrprintf ("* (%s *) %s", name,
11265 core_addr_to_string (addr));
11266 xfree (name);
11267
11268 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
11269 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
11270
11271 /* The above expression is in C. */
11272 b->language = language_c;
11273 }
11274 else
11275 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
11276
11277 if (use_mask)
11278 {
11279 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
11280 }
11281 else
11282 {
11283 w->val = val;
11284 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
11285 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
11286 w->val_valid = 1;
11287 }
11288
11289 if (cond_start)
11290 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
11291 else
11292 b->cond_string = 0;
11293
11294 if (frame)
11295 {
11296 w->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
11297 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
11298 }
11299 else
11300 {
11301 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
11302 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
11303 }
11304
11305 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
11306 {
11307 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
11308 need to act on them together. */
11309 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
11310 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
11311 }
11312
11313 if (!just_location)
11314 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11315
11316 TRY
11317 {
11318 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
11319 that should be inserted. */
11320 update_watchpoint (w, 1);
11321 }
11322 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
11323 {
11324 delete_breakpoint (b);
11325 throw_exception (e);
11326 }
11327 END_CATCH
11328
11329 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 1);
11330 do_cleanups (back_to);
11331 }
11332
11333 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
11334 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
11335
11336 static int
11337 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
11338 {
11339 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
11340 struct value *head = v;
11341
11342 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
11343 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
11344 return 0;
11345
11346 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
11347 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
11348 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
11349 hardware watchpoint.
11350
11351 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
11352 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
11353 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
11354 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
11355 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
11356 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
11357 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
11358 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
11359 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
11360
11361 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
11362 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
11363 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
11364 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
11365 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
11366 {
11367 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
11368 {
11369 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
11370 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
11371 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
11372 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
11373 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
11374 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
11375 ;
11376 else
11377 {
11378 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
11379 it with hardware watchpoints. */
11380 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
11381
11382 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
11383 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
11384 middle of some value chain. */
11385 if (v == head
11386 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
11387 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
11388 {
11389 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
11390 int len;
11391 int num_regs;
11392
11393 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
11394 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
11395 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
11396
11397 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
11398 if (!num_regs)
11399 return 0;
11400 else
11401 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
11402 }
11403 }
11404 }
11405 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
11406 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
11407 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
11408 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
11409 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
11410 }
11411
11412 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
11413 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
11414 return found_memory_cnt;
11415 }
11416
11417 void
11418 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11419 {
11420 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
11421 }
11422
11423 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
11424 calls watch_command_1. */
11425
11426 static void
11427 watch_maybe_just_location (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
11428 {
11429 int just_location = 0;
11430
11431 if (arg
11432 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
11433 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
11434 {
11435 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11436 just_location = 1;
11437 }
11438
11439 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
11440 }
11441
11442 static void
11443 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11444 {
11445 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
11446 }
11447
11448 void
11449 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11450 {
11451 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
11452 }
11453
11454 static void
11455 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11456 {
11457 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
11458 }
11459
11460 void
11461 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11462 {
11463 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
11464 }
11465
11466 static void
11467 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11468 {
11469 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
11470 }
11471 \f
11472
11473 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
11474 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
11475 breakpoints. */
11476
11477 struct until_break_fsm
11478 {
11479 /* The base class. */
11480 struct thread_fsm thread_fsm;
11481
11482 /* The thread that as current when the command was executed. */
11483 int thread;
11484
11485 /* The breakpoint set at the destination location. */
11486 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint;
11487
11488 /* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame. May be
11489 NULL. */
11490 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint;
11491 };
11492
11493 static void until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self);
11494 static int until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self);
11495 static enum async_reply_reason
11496 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self);
11497
11498 /* until_break_fsm's vtable. */
11499
11500 static struct thread_fsm_ops until_break_fsm_ops =
11501 {
11502 NULL, /* dtor */
11503 until_break_fsm_clean_up,
11504 until_break_fsm_should_stop,
11505 NULL, /* return_value */
11506 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason,
11507 };
11508
11509 /* Allocate a new until_break_command_fsm. */
11510
11511 static struct until_break_fsm *
11512 new_until_break_fsm (int thread,
11513 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint,
11514 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint)
11515 {
11516 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11517
11518 sm = XCNEW (struct until_break_fsm);
11519 thread_fsm_ctor (&sm->thread_fsm, &until_break_fsm_ops);
11520
11521 sm->thread = thread;
11522 sm->location_breakpoint = location_breakpoint;
11523 sm->caller_breakpoint = caller_breakpoint;
11524
11525 return sm;
11526 }
11527
11528 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
11529 until(location)/advance commands. */
11530
11531 static int
11532 until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self)
11533 {
11534 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11535 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
11536
11537 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11538 sm->location_breakpoint) != NULL
11539 || (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL
11540 && bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11541 sm->caller_breakpoint) != NULL))
11542 thread_fsm_set_finished (self);
11543
11544 return 1;
11545 }
11546
11547 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
11548 until(location)/advance commands. */
11549
11550 static void
11551 until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self)
11552 {
11553 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11554
11555 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
11556 if (sm->location_breakpoint != NULL)
11557 {
11558 delete_breakpoint (sm->location_breakpoint);
11559 sm->location_breakpoint = NULL;
11560 }
11561 if (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL)
11562 {
11563 delete_breakpoint (sm->caller_breakpoint);
11564 sm->caller_breakpoint = NULL;
11565 }
11566 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (sm->thread);
11567 }
11568
11569 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
11570 until(location)/advance commands. */
11571
11572 static enum async_reply_reason
11573 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self)
11574 {
11575 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
11576 }
11577
11578 void
11579 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11580 {
11581 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
11582 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11583 struct frame_info *frame;
11584 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11585 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11586 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11587 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint;
11588 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint = NULL;
11589 struct cleanup *old_chain, *cleanup;
11590 int thread;
11591 struct thread_info *tp;
11592 struct event_location *location;
11593 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11594
11595 clear_proceed_status (0);
11596
11597 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11598 this function. */
11599
11600 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11601 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
11602
11603 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
11604 sals = decode_line_1 (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11605 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11606 get_last_displayed_line ());
11607 else
11608 sals = decode_line_1 (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11609 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0);
11610
11611 if (sals.nelts != 1)
11612 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11613
11614 sal = sals.sals[0];
11615 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed. */
11616
11617 if (*arg)
11618 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11619
11620 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11621
11622 tp = inferior_thread ();
11623 thread = tp->num;
11624
11625 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11626
11627 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11628 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11629 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11630 that. */
11631
11632 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11633 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11634 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11635 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11636
11637 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11638 one. */
11639
11640 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11641 {
11642 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11643 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11644
11645 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11646 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11647 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11648 caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch,
11649 sal2,
11650 caller_frame_id,
11651 bp_until);
11652 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (caller_breakpoint);
11653
11654 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11655 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
11656 }
11657
11658 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11659 frame = NULL;
11660
11661 if (anywhere)
11662 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11663 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11664 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11665 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11666 else
11667 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11668 only at the very same frame. */
11669 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11670 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11671 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (location_breakpoint);
11672
11673 sm = new_until_break_fsm (tp->num, location_breakpoint, caller_breakpoint);
11674 tp->thread_fsm = &sm->thread_fsm;
11675
11676 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11677
11678 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11679
11680 do_cleanups (cleanup);
11681 }
11682
11683 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11684 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11685
11686 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11687 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11688 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11689 if clause in the arg string. */
11690
11691 char *
11692 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
11693 {
11694 char *cond_string;
11695
11696 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11697 return NULL;
11698
11699 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11700 (*arg) += 2;
11701
11702 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11703 condition string. */
11704 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11705 cond_string = *arg;
11706
11707 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11708 string. */
11709 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11710
11711 return cond_string;
11712 }
11713
11714 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11715 process start/exit, etc. */
11716
11717 typedef enum
11718 {
11719 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11720 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11721 }
11722 catch_fork_kind;
11723
11724 static void
11725 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11726 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11727 {
11728 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11729 char *cond_string = NULL;
11730 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11731 int tempflag;
11732
11733 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11734 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11735 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11736
11737 if (!arg)
11738 arg = "";
11739 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11740
11741 /* The allowed syntax is:
11742 catch [v]fork
11743 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11744
11745 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11746 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11747
11748 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11749 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11750
11751 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11752 and enable reporting of such events. */
11753 switch (fork_kind)
11754 {
11755 case catch_fork_temporary:
11756 case catch_fork_permanent:
11757 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11758 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11759 break;
11760 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11761 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11762 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11763 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11764 break;
11765 default:
11766 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11767 break;
11768 }
11769 }
11770
11771 static void
11772 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11773 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11774 {
11775 struct exec_catchpoint *c;
11776 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11777 int tempflag;
11778 char *cond_string = NULL;
11779
11780 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11781
11782 if (!arg)
11783 arg = "";
11784 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11785
11786 /* The allowed syntax is:
11787 catch exec
11788 catch exec if <cond>
11789
11790 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11791 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11792
11793 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11794 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11795
11796 c = XNEW (struct exec_catchpoint);
11797 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11798 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11799 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11800
11801 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
11802 }
11803
11804 void
11805 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11806 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11807 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11808 char *addr_string,
11809 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11810 int tempflag,
11811 int enabled,
11812 int from_tty)
11813 {
11814 if (from_tty)
11815 {
11816 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11817 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11818 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11819
11820 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11821 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11822 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11823 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11824 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11825 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11826 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11827 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11828 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11829 enough for now, though. */
11830 }
11831
11832 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11833
11834 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11835 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11836 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11837 language_def (language_ada));
11838 b->language = language_ada;
11839 }
11840
11841 static void
11842 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11843 {
11844 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11845 }
11846 \f
11847
11848 static void
11849 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11850 {
11851 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11852 }
11853
11854 /* A qsort comparison function that sorts breakpoints in order. */
11855
11856 static int
11857 compare_breakpoints (const void *a, const void *b)
11858 {
11859 const breakpoint_p *ba = (const breakpoint_p *) a;
11860 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) *ba;
11861 const breakpoint_p *bb = (const breakpoint_p *) b;
11862 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) *bb;
11863
11864 if ((*ba)->number < (*bb)->number)
11865 return -1;
11866 else if ((*ba)->number > (*bb)->number)
11867 return 1;
11868
11869 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11870 the number 0. */
11871 if (ua < ub)
11872 return -1;
11873 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
11874 }
11875
11876 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11877
11878 static void
11879 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11880 {
11881 struct breakpoint *b, *prev;
11882 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
11883 int ix;
11884 int default_match;
11885 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
11886 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11887 int i;
11888 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11889
11890 if (arg)
11891 {
11892 sals = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
11893 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11894 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11895 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
11896 default_match = 0;
11897 }
11898 else
11899 {
11900 sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line);
11901 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
11902 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
11903
11904 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11905 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11906 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11907 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
11908 if (sal.symtab == 0)
11909 error (_("No source file specified."));
11910
11911 sals.sals[0] = sal;
11912 sals.nelts = 1;
11913
11914 default_match = 1;
11915 }
11916
11917 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11918 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11919 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11920 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11921
11922 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11923 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11924 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11925 due to optimization, all in one block.
11926
11927 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11928 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11929 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11930 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11931 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11932 to support that. */
11933
11934 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11935 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11936 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11937 breakpoint. */
11938
11939 found = NULL;
11940 make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (breakpoint_p), &found);
11941 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
11942 {
11943 const char *sal_fullname;
11944
11945 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11946 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11947 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11948 or at default pc.
11949
11950 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11951
11952 0 1 pc
11953 1 1 pc _and_ line
11954 0 0 line
11955 1 0 <can't happen> */
11956
11957 sal = sals.sals[i];
11958 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
11959 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
11960
11961 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11962 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11963 {
11964 int match = 0;
11965 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11966 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11967 {
11968 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
11969 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
11970 {
11971 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11972 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11973 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11974 && sal.pc
11975 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11976 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11977 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11978 || loc->section == sal.section));
11979 int line_match = 0;
11980
11981 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11982 && loc->symtab != NULL
11983 && sal_fullname != NULL
11984 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11985 && loc->line_number == sal.line
11986 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
11987 sal_fullname) == 0)
11988 line_match = 1;
11989
11990 if (pc_match || line_match)
11991 {
11992 match = 1;
11993 break;
11994 }
11995 }
11996 }
11997
11998 if (match)
11999 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
12000 }
12001 }
12002
12003 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
12004 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
12005 {
12006 if (arg)
12007 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
12008 else
12009 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
12010 }
12011
12012 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
12013 qsort (VEC_address (breakpoint_p, found),
12014 VEC_length (breakpoint_p, found),
12015 sizeof (breakpoint_p),
12016 compare_breakpoints);
12017 prev = VEC_index (breakpoint_p, found, 0);
12018 for (ix = 1; VEC_iterate (breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ++ix)
12019 {
12020 if (b == prev)
12021 {
12022 VEC_ordered_remove (breakpoint_p, found, ix);
12023 --ix;
12024 }
12025 }
12026
12027 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
12028 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
12029 if (from_tty)
12030 {
12031 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
12032 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
12033 else
12034 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
12035 }
12036
12037 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
12038 {
12039 if (from_tty)
12040 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
12041 delete_breakpoint (b);
12042 }
12043 if (from_tty)
12044 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
12045
12046 do_cleanups (cleanups);
12047 }
12048 \f
12049 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
12050 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
12051 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
12052
12053 void
12054 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
12055 {
12056 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
12057
12058 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
12059 if (bs->breakpoint_at
12060 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
12061 && bs->stop)
12062 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
12063
12064 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
12065 {
12066 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
12067 delete_breakpoint (b);
12068 }
12069 }
12070
12071 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
12072 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
12073 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
12074 secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and
12075 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
12076 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
12077
12078 static int
12079 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
12080 {
12081 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
12082 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
12083
12084 if (a->address != b->address)
12085 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
12086
12087 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
12088 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
12089 grouped. */
12090
12091 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
12092 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
12093 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
12094
12095 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
12096 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
12097 return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent);
12098
12099 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
12100 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
12101 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
12102
12103 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
12104 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
12105 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
12106
12107 return (a > b) - (a < b);
12108 }
12109
12110 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
12111 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
12112 content of the bp_location array. */
12113
12114 static void
12115 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
12116 {
12117 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
12118
12119 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
12120 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
12121
12122 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
12123 {
12124 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
12125
12126 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
12127 continue;
12128
12129 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
12130 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
12131
12132 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
12133 addr = bl->address - start;
12134 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
12135 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
12136
12137 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
12138
12139 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
12140 addr = end - bl->address;
12141 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
12142 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
12143 }
12144 }
12145
12146 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
12147
12148 static void
12149 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
12150 {
12151 struct breakpoint *b;
12152 struct cleanup *old_chain;
12153 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
12154
12155 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
12156
12157 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
12158 {
12159 struct bp_location *bl;
12160 struct tracepoint *t;
12161 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
12162
12163 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
12164 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
12165 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
12166 continue;
12167
12168 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
12169 {
12170 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
12171 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
12172 else
12173 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
12174 }
12175
12176 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
12177 break;
12178
12179 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
12180 {
12181 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
12182 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
12183 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
12184 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
12185 continue;
12186
12187 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
12188
12189 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
12190
12191 bl->inserted = 1;
12192 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
12193 }
12194 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
12195 t->number_on_target = b->number;
12196 if (bp_location_downloaded)
12197 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
12198 }
12199
12200 do_cleanups (old_chain);
12201 }
12202
12203 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
12204
12205 static void
12206 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
12207 {
12208 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
12209 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
12210 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
12211 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
12212
12213 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
12214 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
12215 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
12216 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
12217 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
12218
12219 left->inserted = right->inserted;
12220 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
12221 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
12222 left->target_info = right->target_info;
12223 right->inserted = left_inserted;
12224 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
12225 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
12226 right->target_info = left_target_info;
12227 }
12228
12229 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
12230 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
12231 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
12232 the target. */
12233
12234 static void
12235 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
12236 {
12237 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
12238 struct bp_location *loc;
12239 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
12240 int pspace_num;
12241
12242 address = bl->address;
12243 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
12244
12245 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
12246 evaluating conditions and if the user has
12247 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
12248 side. */
12249 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
12250 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
12251 return;
12252
12253 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
12254 the same program space as the location
12255 as "its condition has changed". We need to
12256 update the conditions on the target's side. */
12257 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
12258 {
12259 loc = *loc2p;
12260
12261 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
12262 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
12263 continue;
12264
12265 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
12266 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
12267 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
12268 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
12269 that have already been marked. */
12270 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
12271
12272 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
12273 it later on. */
12274 if (loc->cond_bytecode)
12275 {
12276 free_agent_expr (loc->cond_bytecode);
12277 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
12278 }
12279 }
12280 }
12281 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
12282 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
12283 locations are duplicate of which.
12284
12285 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
12286 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
12287 info. */
12288
12289 static void
12290 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12291 {
12292 struct breakpoint *b;
12293 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
12294 struct cleanup *cleanups;
12295 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
12296 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
12297 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
12298 int last_pspace_num = -1;
12299
12300 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
12301 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
12302 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
12303 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
12304 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
12305 once. */
12306 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
12307 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
12308 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
12309 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
12310
12311 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly
12312 built bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
12313 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
12314 unsigned old_location_count;
12315
12316 old_location = bp_location;
12317 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
12318 bp_location = NULL;
12319 bp_location_count = 0;
12320 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
12321
12322 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12323 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
12324 bp_location_count++;
12325
12326 bp_location = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_location_count);
12327 locp = bp_location;
12328 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12329 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
12330 *locp++ = loc;
12331 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
12332 bp_location_compare);
12333
12334 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
12335
12336 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
12337 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
12338 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
12339 if there's another location at the same address (previously
12340 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
12341 location.
12342
12343 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
12344 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
12345
12346 locp = bp_location;
12347 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
12348 old_locp++)
12349 {
12350 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
12351 struct bp_location **loc2p;
12352
12353 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
12354 not, we have to free it. */
12355 int found_object = 0;
12356 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
12357 int keep_in_target = 0;
12358 int removed = 0;
12359
12360 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
12361 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
12362 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
12363 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
12364 locp++;
12365
12366 for (loc2p = locp;
12367 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12368 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12369 loc2p++)
12370 {
12371 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
12372 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
12373 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
12374 place there. */
12375 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
12376 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
12377 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
12378 {
12379 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
12380 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
12381 }
12382
12383 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
12384 found_object = 1;
12385 }
12386
12387 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
12388 have to go through updates again. */
12389 last_addr = old_loc->address;
12390
12391 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
12392 if (!found_object)
12393 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
12394
12395 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
12396 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
12397 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
12398 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
12399 at certain location is not inserted. */
12400
12401 if (old_loc->inserted)
12402 {
12403 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
12404 it. */
12405
12406 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
12407 {
12408 /* The location is still present in the location list,
12409 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
12410 keep_in_target = 1;
12411 }
12412 else
12413 {
12414 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
12415 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
12416 remove its target-side condition. */
12417
12418 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
12419 disabled. See if there's another location at the
12420 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
12421 this one from the target. */
12422
12423 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
12424 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
12425 {
12426 for (loc2p = locp;
12427 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12428 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12429 loc2p++)
12430 {
12431 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
12432
12433 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
12434 {
12435 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
12436 access watchpoints, if the former are not
12437 supported, but the latter are. */
12438 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
12439 {
12440 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
12441 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
12442 }
12443
12444 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
12445 if it should be inserted in case it will be
12446 unduplicated. */
12447 if (loc2 != old_loc
12448 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
12449 {
12450 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
12451 keep_in_target = 1;
12452 break;
12453 }
12454 }
12455 }
12456 }
12457 }
12458
12459 if (!keep_in_target)
12460 {
12461 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
12462 {
12463 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
12464 this location on the global list, and try to
12465 remove it next time, but there's no particular
12466 reason why we will succeed next time.
12467
12468 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
12469 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
12470 only after calling us. */
12471 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
12472 "breakpoint %d\n"),
12473 old_loc->owner->number);
12474 }
12475 removed = 1;
12476 }
12477 }
12478
12479 if (!found_object)
12480 {
12481 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
12482 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
12483 {
12484 /* This location was removed from the target. In
12485 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
12486 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
12487 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
12488 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
12489 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
12490 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
12491 after we see some number of events. The theory here
12492 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
12493 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
12494 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
12495 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
12496 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
12497 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
12498 SIGTRAP.
12499
12500 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
12501 decr_pc_after_break targets.
12502
12503 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
12504 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
12505 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
12506 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
12507 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
12508 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
12509 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
12510 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
12511 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
12512 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
12513 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
12514 targets that do not support new thread events, like
12515 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
12516 thread_count.
12517
12518 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
12519 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
12520 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
12521 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
12522
12523 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
12524 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
12525 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
12526 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
12527 traps we can no longer explain. */
12528
12529 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
12530 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12531
12532 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
12533 }
12534 else
12535 {
12536 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12537 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12538 }
12539 }
12540 }
12541
12542 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12543 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12544 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12545 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12546 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12547 are sorted first for the same address.
12548
12549 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12550 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12551
12552 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12553 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12554 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12555 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12556 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
12557 {
12558 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12559 non-NULL. */
12560 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12561 b = loc->owner;
12562
12563 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12564 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
12565 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12566 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12567 `struct bp_location'. */
12568 || is_tracepoint (b))
12569 {
12570 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12571 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12572 continue;
12573 }
12574
12575 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12576 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12577 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12578 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12579 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12580 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12581 else
12582 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12583
12584 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12585 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12586 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12587 {
12588 *loc_first_p = loc;
12589 loc->duplicate = 0;
12590
12591 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12592 {
12593 loc->needs_update = 1;
12594 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12595 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12596 }
12597 continue;
12598 }
12599
12600
12601 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12602 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12603 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12604 if (loc->inserted)
12605 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12606 loc->duplicate = 1;
12607
12608 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12609 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12610 }
12611
12612 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12613 {
12614 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12615 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12616 else
12617 {
12618 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12619 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12620 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12621 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12622 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12623 "needs_update". */
12624 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12625 }
12626 }
12627
12628 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12629 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12630
12631 do_cleanups (cleanups);
12632 }
12633
12634 void
12635 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12636 {
12637 struct bp_location *loc;
12638 int ix;
12639
12640 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
12641 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12642 {
12643 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12644 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
12645 --ix;
12646 }
12647 }
12648
12649 static void
12650 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12651 {
12652
12653 TRY
12654 {
12655 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12656 }
12657 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12658 {
12659 }
12660 END_CATCH
12661 }
12662
12663 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12664
12665 static void
12666 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12667 {
12668 bpstat bs;
12669
12670 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12671 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12672 {
12673 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12674 bs->old_val = NULL;
12675 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12676 }
12677 }
12678
12679 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12680 static int
12681 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12682 {
12683 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12684
12685 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12686 return 0;
12687 }
12688
12689 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12690 callbacks. */
12691
12692 static void
12693 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12694 {
12695 struct value_print_options opts;
12696
12697 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12698
12699 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12700 single string. */
12701 if (b->loc == NULL)
12702 {
12703 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12704 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12705 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12706 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12707 {
12708 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12709 event_location_to_string (b->location));
12710 }
12711 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12712 {
12713 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12714 event_location_to_string (b->location),
12715 b->extra_string);
12716 }
12717 else
12718 {
12719 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12720 event_location_to_string (b->location),
12721 b->extra_string);
12722 }
12723 }
12724 else
12725 {
12726 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12727 {
12728 printf_filtered (" at ");
12729 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12730 gdb_stdout);
12731 }
12732 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12733 {
12734 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12735 more nicely. */
12736 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12737 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
12738 symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
12739 b->loc->line_number);
12740 else
12741 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12742 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12743 real situation somewhat. */
12744 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12745 event_location_to_string (b->location));
12746 }
12747
12748 if (b->loc->next)
12749 {
12750 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12751 int n = 0;
12752 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12753 ++n;
12754 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12755 }
12756 }
12757 }
12758
12759 /* Default bp_location_ops methods. */
12760
12761 static void
12762 bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self)
12763 {
12764 xfree (self->cond);
12765 if (self->cond_bytecode)
12766 free_agent_expr (self->cond_bytecode);
12767 xfree (self->function_name);
12768
12769 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, self->target_info.conditions);
12770 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, self->target_info.tcommands);
12771 }
12772
12773 static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops =
12774 {
12775 bp_location_dtor
12776 };
12777
12778 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods all breakpoint_ops ultimately
12779 inherit from. */
12780
12781 static void
12782 base_breakpoint_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
12783 {
12784 decref_counted_command_line (&self->commands);
12785 xfree (self->cond_string);
12786 xfree (self->extra_string);
12787 xfree (self->filter);
12788 delete_event_location (self->location);
12789 delete_event_location (self->location_range_end);
12790 }
12791
12792 static struct bp_location *
12793 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12794 {
12795 struct bp_location *loc;
12796
12797 loc = XNEW (struct bp_location);
12798 init_bp_location (loc, &bp_location_ops, self);
12799 return loc;
12800 }
12801
12802 static void
12803 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12804 {
12805 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12806 }
12807
12808 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12809 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12810
12811 static int
12812 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12813 {
12814 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12815 }
12816
12817 static int
12818 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12819 {
12820 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12821 }
12822
12823 static int
12824 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12825 struct address_space *aspace,
12826 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12827 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12828 {
12829 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12830 }
12831
12832 static void
12833 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12834 {
12835 /* Always stop. */
12836 }
12837
12838 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12839 errors. */
12840
12841 static int
12842 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12843 {
12844 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12845 }
12846
12847 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12848 errors. */
12849
12850 static int
12851 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12852 {
12853 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12854 }
12855
12856 static enum print_stop_action
12857 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12858 {
12859 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12860 }
12861
12862 static void
12863 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12864 struct ui_out *uiout)
12865 {
12866 /* nothing */
12867 }
12868
12869 static void
12870 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12871 {
12872 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12873 }
12874
12875 static void
12876 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12877 {
12878 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12879 }
12880
12881 static void
12882 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12883 (const struct event_location *location,
12884 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12885 enum bptype type_wanted)
12886 {
12887 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12888 }
12889
12890 static void
12891 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12892 struct linespec_result *c,
12893 char *cond_string,
12894 char *extra_string,
12895 enum bptype type_wanted,
12896 enum bpdisp disposition,
12897 int thread,
12898 int task, int ignore_count,
12899 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12900 int from_tty, int enabled,
12901 int internal, unsigned flags)
12902 {
12903 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12904 }
12905
12906 static void
12907 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12908 const struct event_location *location,
12909 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
12910 {
12911 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12912 }
12913
12914 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12915
12916 static int
12917 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
12918 {
12919 return 1;
12920 }
12921
12922 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12923
12924 static void
12925 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12926 {
12927 /* Nothing to do. */
12928 }
12929
12930 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12931 {
12932 base_breakpoint_dtor,
12933 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12934 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12935 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12936 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12937 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12938 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12939 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12940 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12941 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12942 NULL,
12943 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12944 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12945 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12946 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
12947 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12948 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
12949 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
12950 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
12951 };
12952
12953 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12954
12955 static void
12956 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12957 {
12958 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12959 if (event_location_empty_p (b->location))
12960 {
12961 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12962 delete_breakpoint (b);
12963 return;
12964 }
12965
12966 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12967 }
12968
12969 static int
12970 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12971 {
12972 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12973 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12974 else
12975 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12976 }
12977
12978 static int
12979 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12980 {
12981 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12982 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12983 else
12984 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12985 }
12986
12987 static int
12988 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12989 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12990 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12991 {
12992 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12993 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12994 return 0;
12995
12996 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12997 aspace, bp_addr))
12998 return 0;
12999
13000 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
13001 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
13002 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
13003 return 0;
13004
13005 return 1;
13006 }
13007
13008 static int
13009 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13010 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13011 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13012 {
13013 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
13014 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
13015 {
13016 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
13017 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
13018 be set at the same address. */
13019 return 0;
13020 }
13021
13022 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
13023 }
13024
13025 static int
13026 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
13027 {
13028 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
13029
13030 return 1;
13031 }
13032
13033 static enum print_stop_action
13034 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13035 {
13036 struct breakpoint *b;
13037 const struct bp_location *bl;
13038 int bp_temp;
13039 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13040
13041 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
13042
13043 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
13044 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13045
13046 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
13047 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
13048 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
13049 bl->address,
13050 b->number, 1);
13051 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
13052 if (bp_temp)
13053 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
13054 else
13055 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
13056 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
13057 {
13058 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
13059 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
13060 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
13061 }
13062 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
13063 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
13064
13065 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
13066 }
13067
13068 static void
13069 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13070 {
13071 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
13072 return;
13073
13074 switch (b->type)
13075 {
13076 case bp_breakpoint:
13077 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
13078 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
13079 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
13080 else
13081 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
13082 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13083 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
13084 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
13085 break;
13086 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
13087 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
13088 break;
13089 case bp_dprintf:
13090 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
13091 break;
13092 }
13093
13094 say_where (b);
13095 }
13096
13097 static void
13098 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13099 {
13100 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
13101 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
13102 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
13103 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
13104 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
13105 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
13106 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
13107 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
13108 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
13109 else
13110 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13111 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
13112
13113 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
13114 event_location_to_string (tp->location));
13115
13116 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
13117 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
13118 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
13119 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
13120
13121 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13122 }
13123
13124 static void
13125 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13126 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13127 enum bptype type_wanted)
13128 {
13129 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13130 }
13131
13132 static void
13133 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13134 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13135 char *cond_string,
13136 char *extra_string,
13137 enum bptype type_wanted,
13138 enum bpdisp disposition,
13139 int thread,
13140 int task, int ignore_count,
13141 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13142 int from_tty, int enabled,
13143 int internal, unsigned flags)
13144 {
13145 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13146 cond_string, extra_string,
13147 type_wanted,
13148 disposition, thread, task,
13149 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13150 enabled, internal, flags);
13151 }
13152
13153 static void
13154 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13155 const struct event_location *location,
13156 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13157 {
13158 decode_location_default (b, location, sals);
13159 }
13160
13161 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
13162
13163 static void
13164 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13165 {
13166 switch (b->type)
13167 {
13168 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
13169 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
13170 case bp_overlay_event:
13171 case bp_longjmp_master:
13172 case bp_std_terminate_master:
13173 case bp_exception_master:
13174 delete_breakpoint (b);
13175 break;
13176
13177 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
13178 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
13179 case bp_shlib_event:
13180
13181 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
13182 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
13183 case bp_thread_event:
13184 break;
13185 }
13186 }
13187
13188 static void
13189 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
13190 {
13191 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
13192 {
13193 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
13194 events. This allows the user to get control and place
13195 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
13196 objects (among other things). */
13197 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
13198 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
13199 }
13200 else
13201 bs->stop = 0;
13202 }
13203
13204 static enum print_stop_action
13205 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13206 {
13207 struct breakpoint *b;
13208
13209 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13210
13211 switch (b->type)
13212 {
13213 case bp_shlib_event:
13214 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
13215 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
13216 to shlib event" message.) */
13217 print_solib_event (0);
13218 break;
13219
13220 case bp_thread_event:
13221 /* Not sure how we will get here.
13222 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
13223 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13224 break;
13225
13226 case bp_overlay_event:
13227 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
13228 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13229 break;
13230
13231 case bp_longjmp_master:
13232 /* These should never be enabled. */
13233 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13234 break;
13235
13236 case bp_std_terminate_master:
13237 /* These should never be enabled. */
13238 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
13239 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
13240 break;
13241
13242 case bp_exception_master:
13243 /* These should never be enabled. */
13244 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
13245 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
13246 break;
13247 }
13248
13249 return PRINT_NOTHING;
13250 }
13251
13252 static void
13253 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13254 {
13255 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
13256 }
13257
13258 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
13259
13260 static void
13261 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13262 {
13263 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
13264 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
13265 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
13266 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
13267 }
13268
13269 static void
13270 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
13271 {
13272 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
13273 }
13274
13275 static enum print_stop_action
13276 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13277 {
13278 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
13279 }
13280
13281 static void
13282 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13283 {
13284 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
13285 }
13286
13287 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
13288
13289 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
13290 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
13291
13292 static void
13293 longjmp_bkpt_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
13294 {
13295 struct thread_info *tp = find_thread_id (self->thread);
13296
13297 if (tp)
13298 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
13299
13300 momentary_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
13301 }
13302
13303 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
13304
13305 static int
13306 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13307 {
13308 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
13309
13310 if (v == 0)
13311 {
13312 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
13313 if needed. */
13314 if (bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore != NULL)
13315 bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
13316 bl->probe.objfile,
13317 bl->gdbarch);
13318 }
13319
13320 return v;
13321 }
13322
13323 static int
13324 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13325 {
13326 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
13327 if (bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore != NULL)
13328 bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
13329 bl->probe.objfile,
13330 bl->gdbarch);
13331
13332 return bkpt_remove_location (bl);
13333 }
13334
13335 static void
13336 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13337 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13338 enum bptype type_wanted)
13339 {
13340 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13341
13342 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, canonical);
13343 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location));
13344 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13345 }
13346
13347 static void
13348 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13349 const struct event_location *location,
13350 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13351 {
13352 *sals = parse_probes (location, NULL);
13353 if (!sals->sals)
13354 error (_("probe not found"));
13355 }
13356
13357 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
13358
13359 static void
13360 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13361 {
13362 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13363 }
13364
13365 static int
13366 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13367 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13368 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13369 {
13370 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
13371 tracepoints. */
13372 return 0;
13373 }
13374
13375 static void
13376 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
13377 struct ui_out *uiout)
13378 {
13379 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13380 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id)
13381 {
13382 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
13383
13384 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmarker id is ");
13385 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
13386 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13387 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
13388 }
13389 }
13390
13391 static void
13392 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13393 {
13394 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
13395 return;
13396
13397 switch (b->type)
13398 {
13399 case bp_tracepoint:
13400 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
13401 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13402 break;
13403 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
13404 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
13405 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13406 break;
13407 case bp_static_tracepoint:
13408 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
13409 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13410 break;
13411 default:
13412 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13413 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
13414 }
13415
13416 say_where (b);
13417 }
13418
13419 static void
13420 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
13421 {
13422 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13423
13424 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
13425 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
13426 if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
13427 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
13428 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
13429 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
13430 else
13431 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13432 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
13433
13434 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
13435 event_location_to_string (self->location));
13436 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
13437
13438 if (tp->pass_count)
13439 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
13440 }
13441
13442 static void
13443 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13444 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13445 enum bptype type_wanted)
13446 {
13447 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13448 }
13449
13450 static void
13451 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13452 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13453 char *cond_string,
13454 char *extra_string,
13455 enum bptype type_wanted,
13456 enum bpdisp disposition,
13457 int thread,
13458 int task, int ignore_count,
13459 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13460 int from_tty, int enabled,
13461 int internal, unsigned flags)
13462 {
13463 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13464 cond_string, extra_string,
13465 type_wanted,
13466 disposition, thread, task,
13467 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13468 enabled, internal, flags);
13469 }
13470
13471 static void
13472 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13473 const struct event_location *location,
13474 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13475 {
13476 decode_location_default (b, location, sals);
13477 }
13478
13479 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
13480
13481 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
13482 static probe. */
13483
13484 static void
13485 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
13486 (const struct event_location *location,
13487 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13488 enum bptype type_wanted)
13489 {
13490 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13491 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
13492 }
13493
13494 static void
13495 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13496 const struct event_location *location,
13497 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13498 {
13499 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13500 bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, sals);
13501 }
13502
13503 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
13504
13505 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
13506
13507 static void
13508 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13509 {
13510 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13511
13512 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
13513 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
13514
13515 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
13516 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
13517 3 - disconnect from target 1
13518 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
13519
13520 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
13521 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
13522 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
13523 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
13524 it all the time. */
13525 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
13526 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
13527 }
13528
13529 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
13530
13531 static void
13532 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13533 {
13534 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
13535 event_location_to_string (tp->location),
13536 tp->extra_string);
13537 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13538 }
13539
13540 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
13541 dprintf.
13542
13543 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
13544 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
13545 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
13546 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
13547 address are all handled. */
13548
13549 static void
13550 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13551 {
13552 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13553 struct bpstats tmp_bs = { NULL };
13554 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13555
13556 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13557 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13558 condition not be evaluated. */
13559 bs->stop = 0;
13560
13561 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13562 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13563 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13564 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13565 commands here throws. */
13566 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13567 bs->commands = NULL;
13568 old_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&tmp_bs.commands);
13569
13570 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13571
13572 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13573 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13574 list. */
13575 do_cleanups (old_chain);
13576 }
13577
13578 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13579 markers (`-m'). */
13580
13581 static void
13582 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13583 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13584 enum bptype type_wanted)
13585 {
13586 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13587 const char *arg_start, *arg;
13588 char *str;
13589 struct cleanup *cleanup;
13590
13591 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location);
13592 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
13593
13594 str = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
13595 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
13596 canonical->location = new_linespec_location (&str);
13597 do_cleanups (cleanup);
13598
13599 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location));
13600 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13601 }
13602
13603 static void
13604 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13605 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13606 char *cond_string,
13607 char *extra_string,
13608 enum bptype type_wanted,
13609 enum bpdisp disposition,
13610 int thread,
13611 int task, int ignore_count,
13612 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13613 int from_tty, int enabled,
13614 int internal, unsigned flags)
13615 {
13616 int i;
13617 struct linespec_sals *lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals,
13618 canonical->sals, 0);
13619
13620 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13621 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13622 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13623 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13624 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13625 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13626
13627 for (i = 0; i < lsal->sals.nelts; ++i)
13628 {
13629 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
13630 struct tracepoint *tp;
13631 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13632 struct event_location *location;
13633
13634 expanded.nelts = 1;
13635 expanded.sals = &lsal->sals.sals[i];
13636
13637 location = copy_event_location (canonical->location);
13638 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
13639
13640 tp = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
13641 init_breakpoint_sal (&tp->base, gdbarch, expanded,
13642 location, NULL,
13643 cond_string, extra_string,
13644 type_wanted, disposition,
13645 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13646 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13647 canonical->special_display);
13648 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13649 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13650 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13651 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13652 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13653 corresponds to this one */
13654 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13655
13656 install_breakpoint (internal, &tp->base, 0);
13657
13658 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
13659 }
13660 }
13661
13662 static void
13663 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13664 const struct event_location *location,
13665 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13666 {
13667 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13668 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location);
13669
13670 *sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13671 if (sals->nelts > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13672 {
13673 sals->sals[0] = sals->sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13674 sals->nelts = 1;
13675 }
13676 else
13677 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13678 }
13679
13680 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13681
13682 static int
13683 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13684 {
13685 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13686 }
13687
13688 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13689 structures. */
13690
13691 void
13692 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13693 {
13694 struct breakpoint *b;
13695
13696 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13697
13698 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13699 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13700 especial culprits.
13701
13702 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13703 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13704 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13705 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13706 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13707 deleted.
13708
13709 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13710 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13711 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13712 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13713 was chosen. */
13714 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13715 return;
13716
13717 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13718 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13719 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13720 {
13721 struct breakpoint *related;
13722 struct watchpoint *w;
13723
13724 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13725 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13726 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13727 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13728 else
13729 w = NULL;
13730 if (w != NULL)
13731 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13732
13733 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13734 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13735 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13736 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13737 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13738 }
13739
13740 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13741 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13742 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13743 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13744 if (bpt->number)
13745 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt);
13746
13747 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13748 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13749
13750 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13751 if (b->next == bpt)
13752 {
13753 b->next = bpt->next;
13754 break;
13755 }
13756
13757 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13758 been freed. */
13759 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13760 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13761 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13762 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13763 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13764 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13765 commands won't work. */
13766
13767 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13768
13769 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13770 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13771 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13772 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13773 might be better design to have location completely
13774 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13775 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13776
13777 bpt->ops->dtor (bpt);
13778 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13779 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13780 bpt->type = bp_none;
13781 xfree (bpt);
13782 }
13783
13784 static void
13785 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
13786 {
13787 delete_breakpoint ((struct breakpoint *) b);
13788 }
13789
13790 struct cleanup *
13791 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
13792 {
13793 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
13794 }
13795
13796 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13797 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13798
13799 static void
13800 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13801 void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
13802 void *),
13803 void *data)
13804 {
13805 struct breakpoint *related;
13806
13807 related = b;
13808 do
13809 {
13810 struct breakpoint *next;
13811
13812 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13813 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13814
13815 if (next == related)
13816 {
13817 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13818 function (related, data);
13819
13820 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13821 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13822 out. */
13823 break;
13824 }
13825 else
13826 function (related, data);
13827
13828 related = next;
13829 }
13830 while (related != b);
13831 }
13832
13833 static void
13834 do_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
13835 {
13836 delete_breakpoint (b);
13837 }
13838
13839 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
13840 delete_breakpoint. */
13841
13842 static void
13843 do_map_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
13844 {
13845 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
13846 }
13847
13848 void
13849 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
13850 {
13851 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13852
13853 dont_repeat ();
13854
13855 if (arg == 0)
13856 {
13857 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13858
13859 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13860 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13861 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13862 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13863 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13864 {
13865 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13866 break;
13867 }
13868
13869 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13870 if (!from_tty
13871 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13872 {
13873 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13874 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13875 delete_breakpoint (b);
13876 }
13877 }
13878 else
13879 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
13880 }
13881
13882 static int
13883 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
13884 {
13885 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
13886 if (!loc->shlib_disabled
13887 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13888 return 0;
13889 return 1;
13890 }
13891
13892 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13893 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13894 Null names are ignored. */
13895
13896 static int
13897 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13898 {
13899 struct bp_location *l;
13900 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
13901 (int (*) (const void *,
13902 const void *)) streq,
13903 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
13904
13905 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13906 {
13907 const char **slot;
13908 const char *name = l->function_name;
13909
13910 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13911 if (name == NULL)
13912 continue;
13913
13914 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
13915 INSERT);
13916 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13917 returns NULL. */
13918 if (*slot != NULL)
13919 {
13920 htab_delete (htab);
13921 return 1;
13922 }
13923 *slot = name;
13924 }
13925
13926 htab_delete (htab);
13927 return 0;
13928 }
13929
13930 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13931 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13932 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13933 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13934 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13935 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13936 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13937 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13938 The heuristic is:
13939
13940 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13941 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13942 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13943 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13944 in the sources, and output a warning.
13945
13946 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13947 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13948 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13949 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13950 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13951 warning.
13952
13953 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13954 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13955 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13956 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13957 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13958 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13959 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13960 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13961 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13962
13963 static struct symtab_and_line
13964 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13965 {
13966 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13967 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13968 CORE_ADDR pc;
13969
13970 pc = sal.pc;
13971 if (sal.line)
13972 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13973
13974 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13975 {
13976 if (strcmp (tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0)
13977 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13978 b->number,
13979 tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id);
13980
13981 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13982 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
13983 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
13984
13985 return sal;
13986 }
13987
13988 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13989 by string ID. */
13990 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13991 && sal.line != 0
13992 && sal.symtab != NULL
13993 && tp->static_trace_marker_id != NULL)
13994 {
13995 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers;
13996
13997 markers
13998 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13999
14000 if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
14001 {
14002 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
14003 struct symbol *sym;
14004 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
14005 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14006 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
14007
14008 tpmarker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0);
14009
14010 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14011 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (tpmarker->str_id);
14012
14013 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
14014 "found at previous line number"),
14015 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14016
14017 init_sal (&sal2);
14018
14019 sal2.pc = tpmarker->address;
14020
14021 sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
14022 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
14023 ui_out_text (uiout, "Now in ");
14024 if (sym)
14025 {
14026 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
14027 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
14028 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
14029 }
14030 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file",
14031 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
14032 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
14033
14034 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
14035 {
14036 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
14037
14038 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
14039 }
14040
14041 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", sal2.line);
14042 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
14043
14044 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
14045 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
14046
14047 delete_event_location (b->location);
14048 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
14049 explicit_loc.source_filename
14050 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
14051 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
14052 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
14053 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
14054
14055 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
14056 so. */
14057
14058 release_static_tracepoint_marker (tpmarker);
14059 }
14060 }
14061 return sal;
14062 }
14063
14064 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
14065 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
14066
14067 static int
14068 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
14069 {
14070 while (a && b)
14071 {
14072 if (a->address != b->address)
14073 return 0;
14074
14075 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
14076 return 0;
14077
14078 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
14079 return 0;
14080
14081 a = a->next;
14082 b = b->next;
14083 }
14084
14085 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
14086 return 0;
14087
14088 return 1;
14089 }
14090
14091 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software breakpoint)
14092 based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not zero, then B is
14093 a ranged breakpoint. */
14094
14095 void
14096 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
14097 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
14098 struct symtabs_and_lines sals_end)
14099 {
14100 int i;
14101 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
14102
14103 if (sals_end.nelts != 0 && (sals.nelts != 1 || sals_end.nelts != 1))
14104 {
14105 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
14106 location. */
14107 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14108 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14109 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
14110 "multiple locations found\n"),
14111 b->number);
14112 return;
14113 }
14114
14115 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
14116 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
14117 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
14118 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
14119 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
14120 individual locations. */
14121 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
14122 return;
14123
14124 b->loc = NULL;
14125
14126 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
14127 {
14128 struct bp_location *new_loc;
14129
14130 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sals.sals[i].pspace);
14131
14132 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
14133
14134 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
14135 old symtab. */
14136 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
14137 {
14138 const char *s;
14139
14140 s = b->cond_string;
14141 TRY
14142 {
14143 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sals.sals[i].pc,
14144 block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
14145 0);
14146 }
14147 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
14148 {
14149 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
14150 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
14151 b->number, e.message);
14152 new_loc->enabled = 0;
14153 }
14154 END_CATCH
14155 }
14156
14157 if (sals_end.nelts)
14158 {
14159 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end.sals[0]);
14160
14161 new_loc->length = end - sals.sals[0].pc + 1;
14162 }
14163 }
14164
14165 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
14166 breakpoints. */
14167 {
14168 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
14169 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
14170 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
14171 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
14172 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
14173 often enough until a better solution is found. */
14174 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
14175
14176 for (; e; e = e->next)
14177 {
14178 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
14179 {
14180 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
14181 if (have_ambiguous_names)
14182 {
14183 for (; l; l = l->next)
14184 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
14185 {
14186 l->enabled = 0;
14187 break;
14188 }
14189 }
14190 else
14191 {
14192 for (; l; l = l->next)
14193 if (l->function_name
14194 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
14195 {
14196 l->enabled = 0;
14197 break;
14198 }
14199 }
14200 }
14201 }
14202 }
14203
14204 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
14205 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14206
14207 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14208 }
14209
14210 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
14211 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
14212
14213 static struct symtabs_and_lines
14214 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
14215 int *found)
14216 {
14217 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
14218 struct gdb_exception exception = exception_none;
14219
14220 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
14221
14222 TRY
14223 {
14224 b->ops->decode_location (b, location, &sals);
14225 }
14226 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
14227 {
14228 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
14229
14230 exception = e;
14231
14232 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
14233 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
14234 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
14235 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
14236 state, then user already saw the message about that
14237 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
14238 errors. */
14239 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
14240 && (b->condition_not_parsed
14241 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
14242 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
14243 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
14244 not_found_and_ok = 1;
14245
14246 if (!not_found_and_ok)
14247 {
14248 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
14249 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
14250 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
14251 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
14252 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
14253 which approach is better. */
14254 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14255 throw_exception (e);
14256 }
14257 }
14258 END_CATCH
14259
14260 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
14261 {
14262 int i;
14263
14264 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
14265 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[i]);
14266 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
14267 {
14268 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
14269 int thread, task;
14270
14271 find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals.sals[0].pc,
14272 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
14273 &extra_string);
14274 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
14275 if (cond_string)
14276 b->cond_string = cond_string;
14277 b->thread = thread;
14278 b->task = task;
14279 if (extra_string)
14280 {
14281 xfree (b->extra_string);
14282 b->extra_string = extra_string;
14283 }
14284 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
14285 }
14286
14287 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
14288 sals.sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals.sals[0]);
14289
14290 *found = 1;
14291 }
14292 else
14293 *found = 0;
14294
14295 return sals;
14296 }
14297
14298 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
14299 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
14300 locations. */
14301
14302 static void
14303 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
14304 {
14305 int found;
14306 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, sals_end;
14307 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
14308 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded_end = {0};
14309
14310 sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location, &found);
14311 if (found)
14312 {
14313 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
14314 expanded = sals;
14315 }
14316
14317 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
14318 {
14319 sals_end = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end, &found);
14320 if (found)
14321 {
14322 make_cleanup (xfree, sals_end.sals);
14323 expanded_end = sals_end;
14324 }
14325 }
14326
14327 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded, expanded_end);
14328 }
14329
14330 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
14331 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
14332
14333 static void
14334 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
14335 struct linespec_result *canonical,
14336 enum bptype type_wanted)
14337 {
14338 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
14339 }
14340
14341 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
14342 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
14343 breakpoint_ops. */
14344
14345 static void
14346 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14347 struct linespec_result *canonical,
14348 char *cond_string,
14349 char *extra_string,
14350 enum bptype type_wanted,
14351 enum bpdisp disposition,
14352 int thread,
14353 int task, int ignore_count,
14354 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
14355 int from_tty, int enabled,
14356 int internal, unsigned flags)
14357 {
14358 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical, cond_string,
14359 extra_string,
14360 type_wanted, disposition,
14361 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
14362 enabled, internal, flags);
14363 }
14364
14365 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
14366 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
14367
14368 static void
14369 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
14370 const struct event_location *location,
14371 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
14372 {
14373 struct linespec_result canonical;
14374
14375 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
14376 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
14377 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
14378 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
14379 b->filter);
14380
14381 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
14382 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) < 2);
14383
14384 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 0)
14385 {
14386 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
14387
14388 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
14389 *sals = lsal->sals;
14390 /* Arrange it so the destructor does not free the
14391 contents. */
14392 lsal->sals.sals = NULL;
14393 }
14394
14395 destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
14396 }
14397
14398 /* Prepare the global context for a re-set of breakpoint B. */
14399
14400 static struct cleanup *
14401 prepare_re_set_context (struct breakpoint *b)
14402 {
14403 struct cleanup *cleanups;
14404
14405 input_radix = b->input_radix;
14406 cleanups = save_current_space_and_thread ();
14407 if (b->pspace != NULL)
14408 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
14409 set_language (b->language);
14410
14411 return cleanups;
14412 }
14413
14414 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
14415 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
14416 Unused in this case. */
14417
14418 static int
14419 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
14420 {
14421 /* Get past catch_errs. */
14422 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
14423 struct cleanup *cleanups;
14424
14425 cleanups = prepare_re_set_context (b);
14426 b->ops->re_set (b);
14427 do_cleanups (cleanups);
14428 return 0;
14429 }
14430
14431 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
14432 void
14433 breakpoint_re_set (void)
14434 {
14435 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14436 enum language save_language;
14437 int save_input_radix;
14438 struct cleanup *old_chain;
14439
14440 save_language = current_language->la_language;
14441 save_input_radix = input_radix;
14442 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
14443
14444 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14445 {
14446 /* Format possible error msg. */
14447 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
14448 b->number);
14449 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
14450 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
14451 do_cleanups (cleanups);
14452 }
14453 set_language (save_language);
14454 input_radix = save_input_radix;
14455
14456 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
14457
14458 do_cleanups (old_chain);
14459
14460 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
14461 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
14462 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
14463 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
14464 }
14465 \f
14466 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
14467
14468 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
14469 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
14470 void
14471 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
14472 {
14473 if (b->thread != -1)
14474 {
14475 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
14476 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
14477
14478 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
14479 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
14480 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
14481 as well. */
14482 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
14483 }
14484 }
14485
14486 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14487 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14488 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14489
14490 void
14491 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
14492 {
14493 struct breakpoint *b;
14494
14495 if (count < 0)
14496 count = 0;
14497
14498 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14499 if (b->number == bptnum)
14500 {
14501 if (is_tracepoint (b))
14502 {
14503 if (from_tty && count != 0)
14504 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
14505 bptnum);
14506 return;
14507 }
14508
14509 b->ignore_count = count;
14510 if (from_tty)
14511 {
14512 if (count == 0)
14513 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
14514 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
14515 bptnum);
14516 else if (count == 1)
14517 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
14518 bptnum);
14519 else
14520 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
14521 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
14522 count, bptnum);
14523 }
14524 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14525 return;
14526 }
14527
14528 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
14529 }
14530
14531 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
14532
14533 static void
14534 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14535 {
14536 char *p = args;
14537 int num;
14538
14539 if (p == 0)
14540 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
14541
14542 num = get_number (&p);
14543 if (num == 0)
14544 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
14545 if (*p == 0)
14546 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
14547
14548 set_ignore_count (num,
14549 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
14550 from_tty);
14551 if (from_tty)
14552 printf_filtered ("\n");
14553 }
14554 \f
14555 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
14556 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
14557
14558 static void
14559 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
14560 void *),
14561 void *data)
14562 {
14563 int num;
14564 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
14565 int match;
14566 struct get_number_or_range_state state;
14567
14568 if (args == 0 || *args == '\0')
14569 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14570
14571 init_number_or_range (&state, args);
14572
14573 while (!state.finished)
14574 {
14575 const char *p = state.string;
14576
14577 match = 0;
14578
14579 num = get_number_or_range (&state);
14580 if (num == 0)
14581 {
14582 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
14583 }
14584 else
14585 {
14586 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
14587 if (b->number == num)
14588 {
14589 match = 1;
14590 function (b, data);
14591 break;
14592 }
14593 if (match == 0)
14594 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
14595 }
14596 }
14597 }
14598
14599 static struct bp_location *
14600 find_location_by_number (char *number)
14601 {
14602 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
14603 char *p1;
14604 int bp_num;
14605 int loc_num;
14606 struct breakpoint *b;
14607 struct bp_location *loc;
14608
14609 *dot = '\0';
14610
14611 p1 = number;
14612 bp_num = get_number (&p1);
14613 if (bp_num == 0)
14614 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14615
14616 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14617 if (b->number == bp_num)
14618 {
14619 break;
14620 }
14621
14622 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14623 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14624
14625 p1 = dot+1;
14626 loc_num = get_number (&p1);
14627 if (loc_num == 0)
14628 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
14629
14630 --loc_num;
14631 loc = b->loc;
14632 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
14633 ;
14634 if (!loc)
14635 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
14636
14637 return loc;
14638 }
14639
14640
14641 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14642 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14643 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14644
14645 void
14646 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14647 {
14648 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14649 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14650 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14651 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14652 return;
14653
14654 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14655
14656 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14657 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14658
14659 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14660 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14661 {
14662 struct bp_location *location;
14663
14664 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14665 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14666 }
14667
14668 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14669
14670 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14671 }
14672
14673 /* A callback for iterate_over_related_breakpoints. */
14674
14675 static void
14676 do_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14677 {
14678 disable_breakpoint (b);
14679 }
14680
14681 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
14682 disable_breakpoint. */
14683
14684 static void
14685 do_map_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14686 {
14687 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14688 }
14689
14690 static void
14691 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14692 {
14693 if (args == 0)
14694 {
14695 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14696
14697 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14698 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14699 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14700 }
14701 else
14702 {
14703 char *num = extract_arg (&args);
14704
14705 while (num)
14706 {
14707 if (strchr (num, '.'))
14708 {
14709 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num);
14710
14711 if (loc)
14712 {
14713 if (loc->enabled)
14714 {
14715 loc->enabled = 0;
14716 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14717 }
14718 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14719 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14720 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14721 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14722 }
14723 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14724 }
14725 else
14726 map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14727 num = extract_arg (&args);
14728 }
14729 }
14730 }
14731
14732 static void
14733 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14734 int count)
14735 {
14736 int target_resources_ok;
14737
14738 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14739 {
14740 int i;
14741 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14742 target_resources_ok =
14743 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14744 i + 1, 0);
14745 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14746 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14747 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14748 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14749 }
14750
14751 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14752 {
14753 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14754 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14755
14756 TRY
14757 {
14758 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14759
14760 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14761 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14762 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14763 }
14764 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14765 {
14766 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14767 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14768 bpt->number);
14769 return;
14770 }
14771 END_CATCH
14772 }
14773
14774 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14775
14776 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14777 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14778
14779 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14780 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14781 {
14782 struct bp_location *location;
14783
14784 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14785 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14786 }
14787
14788 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14789 bpt->enable_count = count;
14790 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14791
14792 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14793 }
14794
14795
14796 void
14797 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14798 {
14799 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14800 }
14801
14802 static void
14803 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
14804 {
14805 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14806 }
14807
14808 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
14809 enable_breakpoint. */
14810
14811 static void
14812 do_map_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14813 {
14814 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
14815 }
14816
14817 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
14818 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
14819 in stopping the inferior. */
14820
14821 static void
14822 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14823 {
14824 if (args == 0)
14825 {
14826 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14827
14828 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14829 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14830 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14831 }
14832 else
14833 {
14834 char *num = extract_arg (&args);
14835
14836 while (num)
14837 {
14838 if (strchr (num, '.'))
14839 {
14840 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num);
14841
14842 if (loc)
14843 {
14844 if (!loc->enabled)
14845 {
14846 loc->enabled = 1;
14847 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14848 }
14849 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14850 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14851 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14852 target_enable_tracepoint (loc);
14853 }
14854 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14855 }
14856 else
14857 map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
14858 num = extract_arg (&args);
14859 }
14860 }
14861 }
14862
14863 /* This struct packages up disposition data for application to multiple
14864 breakpoints. */
14865
14866 struct disp_data
14867 {
14868 enum bpdisp disp;
14869 int count;
14870 };
14871
14872 static void
14873 do_enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
14874 {
14875 struct disp_data disp_data = *(struct disp_data *) arg;
14876
14877 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_data.disp, disp_data.count);
14878 }
14879
14880 static void
14881 do_map_enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
14882 {
14883 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, 1 };
14884
14885 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
14886 }
14887
14888 static void
14889 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14890 {
14891 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_once_breakpoint, NULL);
14892 }
14893
14894 static void
14895 do_map_enable_count_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *countptr)
14896 {
14897 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, *(int *) countptr };
14898
14899 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
14900 }
14901
14902 static void
14903 enable_count_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14904 {
14905 int count;
14906
14907 if (args == NULL)
14908 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14909
14910 count = get_number (&args);
14911
14912 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_count_breakpoint, &count);
14913 }
14914
14915 static void
14916 do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
14917 {
14918 struct disp_data disp = { disp_del, 1 };
14919
14920 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
14921 }
14922
14923 static void
14924 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14925 {
14926 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
14927 }
14928 \f
14929 static void
14930 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
14931 {
14932 }
14933
14934 static void
14935 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
14936 {
14937 }
14938
14939 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14940 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14941 GDB itself. */
14942
14943 static void
14944 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
14945 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
14946 const bfd_byte *data)
14947 {
14948 struct breakpoint *bp;
14949
14950 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
14951 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14952 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14953 {
14954 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14955
14956 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val)
14957 {
14958 struct bp_location *loc;
14959
14960 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14961 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14962 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14963 && addr + len > loc->address)
14964 {
14965 value_free (wp->val);
14966 wp->val = NULL;
14967 wp->val_valid = 0;
14968 }
14969 }
14970 }
14971 }
14972
14973 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14974
14975 void
14976 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14977 struct address_space *aspace,
14978 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
14979 {
14980 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
14981 struct symtab_and_line sal;
14982 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
14983
14984 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
14985 {
14986 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
14987 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->num, gdbarch);
14988 }
14989
14990 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
14991 sal.pc = pc;
14992 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
14993 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
14994 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
14995
14996 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
14997 }
14998
14999 /* See breakpoint.h. */
15000
15001 int
15002 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
15003 struct address_space *aspace,
15004 CORE_ADDR pc)
15005 {
15006 struct bp_location *loc;
15007
15008 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
15009 if (loc->inserted
15010 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
15011 return 1;
15012
15013 return 0;
15014 }
15015
15016 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
15017 PC. */
15018
15019 int
15020 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
15021 CORE_ADDR pc)
15022 {
15023 struct breakpoint *bpt;
15024
15025 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
15026 {
15027 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
15028 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
15029 return 1;
15030 }
15031 return 0;
15032 }
15033
15034 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
15035
15036 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
15037 static void
15038 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
15039 {
15040 tracepoint_count = num;
15041 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
15042 }
15043
15044 static void
15045 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15046 {
15047 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15048 struct event_location *location;
15049 struct cleanup *back_to;
15050
15051 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
15052 back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15053 if (location != NULL
15054 && event_location_type (location) == PROBE_LOCATION)
15055 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15056 else
15057 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15058
15059 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15060 location,
15061 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
15062 0 /* tempflag */,
15063 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15064 0 /* Ignore count */,
15065 pending_break_support,
15066 ops,
15067 from_tty,
15068 1 /* enabled */,
15069 0 /* internal */, 0);
15070 do_cleanups (back_to);
15071 }
15072
15073 static void
15074 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15075 {
15076 struct event_location *location;
15077 struct cleanup *back_to;
15078
15079 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
15080 back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15081 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15082 location,
15083 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
15084 0 /* tempflag */,
15085 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15086 0 /* Ignore count */,
15087 pending_break_support,
15088 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
15089 from_tty,
15090 1 /* enabled */,
15091 0 /* internal */, 0);
15092 do_cleanups (back_to);
15093 }
15094
15095 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
15096
15097 static void
15098 strace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15099 {
15100 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15101 struct event_location *location;
15102 struct cleanup *back_to;
15103
15104 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
15105 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
15106 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
15107 {
15108 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15109 location = new_linespec_location (&arg);
15110 }
15111 else
15112 {
15113 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15114 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
15115 }
15116
15117 back_to = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15118 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15119 location,
15120 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
15121 0 /* tempflag */,
15122 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15123 0 /* Ignore count */,
15124 pending_break_support,
15125 ops,
15126 from_tty,
15127 1 /* enabled */,
15128 0 /* internal */, 0);
15129 do_cleanups (back_to);
15130 }
15131
15132 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
15133 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
15134
15135 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
15136 static int next_cmd;
15137
15138 static char *
15139 read_uploaded_action (void)
15140 {
15141 char *rslt;
15142
15143 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt);
15144
15145 next_cmd++;
15146
15147 return rslt;
15148 }
15149
15150 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
15151 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
15152 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
15153 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
15154 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
15155
15156 struct tracepoint *
15157 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
15158 {
15159 char *addr_str, small_buf[100];
15160 struct tracepoint *tp;
15161 struct event_location *location;
15162 struct cleanup *cleanup;
15163
15164 if (utp->at_string)
15165 addr_str = utp->at_string;
15166 else
15167 {
15168 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
15169 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
15170 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
15171 user. */
15172 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
15173 "source location, using raw address"),
15174 utp->number);
15175 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
15176 addr_str = small_buf;
15177 }
15178
15179 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
15180 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
15181 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
15182 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
15183 utp->number);
15184
15185 location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str, current_language);
15186 cleanup = make_cleanup_delete_event_location (location);
15187 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15188 location,
15189 utp->cond_string, -1, addr_str,
15190 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
15191 0 /* tempflag */,
15192 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
15193 0 /* Ignore count */,
15194 pending_break_support,
15195 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
15196 0 /* from_tty */,
15197 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
15198 0 /* internal */,
15199 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
15200 {
15201 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15202 return NULL;
15203 }
15204
15205 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15206
15207 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
15208 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
15209 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
15210
15211 if (utp->pass > 0)
15212 {
15213 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
15214 tp->base.number);
15215
15216 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
15217 }
15218
15219 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
15220 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
15221 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
15222 function. */
15223 if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings))
15224 {
15225 struct command_line *cmd_list;
15226
15227 this_utp = utp;
15228 next_cmd = 0;
15229
15230 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL);
15231
15232 breakpoint_set_commands (&tp->base, cmd_list);
15233 }
15234 else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions)
15235 || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions))
15236 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
15237 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
15238 utp->number);
15239
15240 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
15241 tp->base.hit_count = utp->hit_count;
15242 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
15243
15244 return tp;
15245 }
15246
15247 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
15248 omitted. */
15249
15250 static void
15251 tracepoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
15252 {
15253 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
15254 int num_printed;
15255
15256 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
15257
15258 if (num_printed == 0)
15259 {
15260 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
15261 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
15262 else
15263 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
15264 }
15265
15266 default_collect_info ();
15267 }
15268
15269 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
15270 Not supported by all targets. */
15271 static void
15272 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15273 {
15274 enable_command (args, from_tty);
15275 }
15276
15277 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
15278 Not supported by all targets. */
15279 static void
15280 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15281 {
15282 disable_command (args, from_tty);
15283 }
15284
15285 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
15286 static void
15287 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15288 {
15289 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15290
15291 dont_repeat ();
15292
15293 if (arg == 0)
15294 {
15295 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
15296
15297 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
15298 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
15299 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
15300 argument. */
15301 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15302 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15303 {
15304 breaks_to_delete = 1;
15305 break;
15306 }
15307
15308 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
15309 if (!from_tty
15310 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
15311 {
15312 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15313 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15314 delete_breakpoint (b);
15315 }
15316 }
15317 else
15318 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
15319 }
15320
15321 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
15322
15323 static void
15324 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
15325 {
15326 tp->pass_count = count;
15327 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (&tp->base);
15328 if (from_tty)
15329 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
15330 tp->base.number, count);
15331 }
15332
15333 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
15334
15335 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
15336 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
15337 Also accepts special argument "all". */
15338
15339 static void
15340 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15341 {
15342 struct tracepoint *t1;
15343 unsigned int count;
15344
15345 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
15346 error (_("passcount command requires an "
15347 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
15348
15349 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
15350
15351 args = skip_spaces (args);
15352 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
15353 {
15354 struct breakpoint *b;
15355
15356 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
15357 if (*args)
15358 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
15359
15360 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15361 {
15362 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15363 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15364 }
15365 }
15366 else if (*args == '\0')
15367 {
15368 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
15369 if (t1)
15370 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15371 }
15372 else
15373 {
15374 struct get_number_or_range_state state;
15375
15376 init_number_or_range (&state, args);
15377 while (!state.finished)
15378 {
15379 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &state);
15380 if (t1)
15381 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15382 }
15383 }
15384 }
15385
15386 struct tracepoint *
15387 get_tracepoint (int num)
15388 {
15389 struct breakpoint *t;
15390
15391 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15392 if (t->number == num)
15393 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15394
15395 return NULL;
15396 }
15397
15398 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
15399 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
15400 reconnecting). */
15401
15402 struct tracepoint *
15403 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
15404 {
15405 struct breakpoint *b;
15406
15407 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15408 {
15409 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15410
15411 if (t->number_on_target == num)
15412 return t;
15413 }
15414
15415 return NULL;
15416 }
15417
15418 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
15419 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
15420 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
15421 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
15422
15423 struct tracepoint *
15424 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg,
15425 struct get_number_or_range_state *state)
15426 {
15427 struct breakpoint *t;
15428 int tpnum;
15429 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
15430
15431 if (state)
15432 {
15433 gdb_assert (!state->finished);
15434 tpnum = get_number_or_range (state);
15435 }
15436 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
15437 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
15438 else
15439 tpnum = get_number (arg);
15440
15441 if (tpnum <= 0)
15442 {
15443 if (instring && *instring)
15444 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
15445 instring);
15446 else
15447 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
15448 return NULL;
15449 }
15450
15451 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15452 if (t->number == tpnum)
15453 {
15454 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15455 }
15456
15457 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
15458 return NULL;
15459 }
15460
15461 void
15462 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
15463 {
15464 if (b->thread != -1)
15465 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
15466
15467 if (b->task != 0)
15468 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15469
15470 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15471 }
15472
15473 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15474 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15475 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15476 non-zero. */
15477
15478 static void
15479 save_breakpoints (char *filename, int from_tty,
15480 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15481 {
15482 struct breakpoint *tp;
15483 int any = 0;
15484 struct cleanup *cleanup;
15485 struct ui_file *fp;
15486 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15487
15488 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15489 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15490
15491 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15492 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15493 {
15494 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15495 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15496 continue;
15497
15498 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15499 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15500 continue;
15501
15502 any = 1;
15503
15504 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15505 {
15506 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15507
15508 /* We can stop searching. */
15509 break;
15510 }
15511 }
15512
15513 if (!any)
15514 {
15515 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15516 return;
15517 }
15518
15519 filename = tilde_expand (filename);
15520 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, filename);
15521 fp = gdb_fopen (filename, "w");
15522 if (!fp)
15523 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15524 filename, safe_strerror (errno));
15525 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (fp);
15526
15527 if (extra_trace_bits)
15528 save_trace_state_variables (fp);
15529
15530 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15531 {
15532 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15533 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15534 continue;
15535
15536 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15537 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15538 continue;
15539
15540 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, fp);
15541
15542 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15543 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15544 instead. */
15545
15546 if (tp->cond_string)
15547 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15548
15549 if (tp->ignore_count)
15550 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15551
15552 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15553 {
15554 struct gdb_exception exception;
15555
15556 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " commands\n");
15557
15558 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, fp);
15559 TRY
15560 {
15561 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands->commands, 2);
15562 }
15563 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15564 {
15565 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, NULL);
15566 throw_exception (ex);
15567 }
15568 END_CATCH
15569
15570 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, NULL);
15571 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " end\n");
15572 }
15573
15574 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15575 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum\n");
15576
15577 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15578 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15579 special, and not user visible. */
15580 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15581 {
15582 struct bp_location *loc;
15583 int n = 1;
15584
15585 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15586 if (!loc->enabled)
15587 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15588 }
15589 }
15590
15591 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15592 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15593
15594 if (from_tty)
15595 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), filename);
15596 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15597 }
15598
15599 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15600
15601 static void
15602 save_breakpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15603 {
15604 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15605 }
15606
15607 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15608
15609 static void
15610 save_tracepoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15611 {
15612 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15613 }
15614
15615 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15616
15617 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
15618 all_tracepoints (void)
15619 {
15620 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
15621 struct breakpoint *tp;
15622
15623 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15624 {
15625 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
15626 }
15627
15628 return tp_vec;
15629 }
15630
15631 \f
15632 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15633 locations used by several commands. */
15634
15635 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15636 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15637 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15638 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15639 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15640 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15641 \n\
15642 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15643 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15644 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15645 \n\
15646 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15647 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15648 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15649 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15650 -function fact -label the_top\".\n"
15651
15652 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15653 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15654 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15655 command. */
15656
15657 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15658 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15659 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15660 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15661 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15662 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15663 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15664 below.\n\
15665 \n\
15666 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15667 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15668 \n\
15669 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15670 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15671 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15672 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15673 conditions are different.\n\
15674 \n\
15675 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15676
15677 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15678 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15679
15680 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15681 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15682
15683 void
15684 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
15685 cmd_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15686 completer_ftype *completer,
15687 void *user_data_catch,
15688 void *user_data_tcatch)
15689 {
15690 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15691
15692 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
15693 &catch_cmdlist);
15694 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15695 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15696 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15697
15698 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
15699 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15700 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15701 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15702 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15703 }
15704
15705 static void
15706 save_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15707 {
15708 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15709 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15710 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
15711 }
15712
15713 struct breakpoint *
15714 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15715 void *data)
15716 {
15717 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15718
15719 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15720 {
15721 if ((*callback) (b, data))
15722 return b;
15723 }
15724
15725 return NULL;
15726 }
15727
15728 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15729 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15730
15731 static int
15732 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15733 {
15734 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15735 non-inline function. */
15736 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15737 return 1;
15738
15739 return 0;
15740 }
15741
15742 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15743 have been inlined. */
15744
15745 int
15746 pc_at_non_inline_function (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15747 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15748 {
15749 struct breakpoint *b;
15750 struct bp_location *bl;
15751
15752 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15753 {
15754 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15755 continue;
15756
15757 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15758 {
15759 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15760 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15761 return 1;
15762 }
15763 }
15764
15765 return 0;
15766 }
15767
15768 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15769
15770 void
15771 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15772 {
15773 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
15774
15775 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
15776 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15777 loc->symtab = NULL;
15778 }
15779
15780 void
15781 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15782 {
15783 static int initialized = 0;
15784
15785 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15786
15787 if (initialized)
15788 return;
15789 initialized = 1;
15790
15791 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15792 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15793 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15794 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15795 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15796 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15797 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15798 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15799 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15800 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
15801 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15802 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
15803
15804 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15805 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15806 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15807 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15808 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15809 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15810 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15811 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15812
15813 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15814 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15815 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15816 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15817 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15818 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15819 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15820 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15821 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15822 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15823
15824 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15825 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15826 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15827 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15828 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15829 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15830 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15831
15832 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15833 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15834 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15835 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15836 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15837 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15838 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15839
15840 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception. */
15841 ops = &longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
15842 *ops = momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15843 ops->dtor = longjmp_bkpt_dtor;
15844
15845 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15846 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15847 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15848 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15849 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15850 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15851 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
15852
15853 /* Watchpoints. */
15854 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15855 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15856 ops->dtor = dtor_watchpoint;
15857 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15858 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15859 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15860 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15861 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15862 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15863 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15864 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15865 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15866 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15867 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
15868
15869 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15870 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15871 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15872 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15873 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15874 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15875 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15876 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15877 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15878 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15879 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15880
15881 /* Tracepoints. */
15882 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15883 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15884 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15885 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15886 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15887 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15888 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15889 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
15890 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15891 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
15892
15893 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15894 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15895 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15896 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15897 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
15898
15899 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15900 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15901 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15902 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
15903 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15904 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
15905
15906 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15907 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15908 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15909 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15910 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15911 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15912 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15913 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15914 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15915 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15916
15917 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15918 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15919 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15920 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15921 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15922 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15923 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15924 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15925 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15926 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15927
15928 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15929 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15930 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15931 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exec;
15932 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15933 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15934 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15935 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15936 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15937 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15938 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15939
15940 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15941 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15942 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15943 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_solib;
15944 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15945 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15946 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15947 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15948 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15949 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15950 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15951 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15952
15953 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15954 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15955 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
15956 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15957 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15958 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15959 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
15960 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
15961 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
15962 }
15963
15964 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15965
15966 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
15967
15968 void
15969 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
15970 {
15971 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15972
15973 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15974
15975 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
15976 observer_attach_free_objfile (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
15977 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
15978
15979 breakpoint_objfile_key
15980 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_probes);
15981
15982 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15983 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15984 before a breakpoint is set. */
15985 breakpoint_count = 0;
15986
15987 tracepoint_count = 0;
15988
15989 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15990 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15991 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15992
15993 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
15994 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
15995 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15996 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15997 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15998 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15999 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
16000 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
16001
16002 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
16003 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
16004 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
16005 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
16006 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
16007
16008 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
16009 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
16010 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
16011 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
16012 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
16013 \n"
16014 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
16015 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16016
16017 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
16018 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
16019 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
16020 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
16021 \n"
16022 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
16023 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16024
16025 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
16026 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
16027 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
16028 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
16029 \n"
16030 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
16031 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16032
16033 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
16034 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
16035 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
16036 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
16037 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
16038 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
16039 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
16040
16041 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16042
16043 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
16044 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
16045 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
16046 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
16047 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
16048 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
16049
16050 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
16051 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16052 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
16053 &enablebreaklist);
16054
16055 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
16056 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16057 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
16058 &enablebreaklist);
16059
16060 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
16061 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
16062 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
16063 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
16064 &enablebreaklist);
16065
16066 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
16067 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16068 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
16069 &enablelist);
16070
16071 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
16072 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16073 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
16074 &enablelist);
16075
16076 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
16077 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
16078 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
16079 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
16080 &enablelist);
16081
16082 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
16083 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16084 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16085 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16086 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
16087 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
16088 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16089 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16090
16091 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
16092 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16093 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16094 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16095 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
16096 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
16097 &disablelist);
16098
16099 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
16100 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
16101 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16102 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16103 \n\
16104 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
16105 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
16106 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
16107 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
16108 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
16109
16110 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
16111 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
16112 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16113 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16114 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
16115 &deletelist);
16116
16117 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
16118 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
16119 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
16120 \n\
16121 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
16122 is executing in.\n"
16123 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
16124 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
16125 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
16126
16127 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
16128 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
16129 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
16130 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16131
16132 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
16133 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
16134 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
16135 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
16136
16137 if (dbx_commands)
16138 {
16139 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
16140 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
16141 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
16142 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
16143 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
16144 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
16145 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
16146 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
16147 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16148 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16149 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16150 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16151 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16152 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16153 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16154 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16155 \n\
16156 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16157 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16158 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16159 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16160 breakpoint set."));
16161 }
16162
16163 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
16164 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
16165 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16166 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16167 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16168 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16169 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16170 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16171 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16172 \n\
16173 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16174 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16175 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16176 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16177 breakpoint set."));
16178
16179 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
16180
16181 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
16182 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16183 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16184 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16185 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16186 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
16187 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
16188 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
16189 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
16190 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16191 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16192 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16193 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16194 \n\
16195 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16196 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16197 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16198 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16199 breakpoint set."),
16200 &maintenanceinfolist);
16201
16202 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
16203 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
16204 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
16205 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16206
16207 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
16208 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
16209 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
16210 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16211
16212 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
16213 catch_fork_command_1,
16214 NULL,
16215 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
16216 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
16217 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
16218 catch_fork_command_1,
16219 NULL,
16220 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
16221 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
16222 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
16223 catch_exec_command_1,
16224 NULL,
16225 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16226 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16227 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
16228 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
16229 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
16230 catch_load_command_1,
16231 NULL,
16232 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16233 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16234 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
16235 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
16236 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
16237 catch_unload_command_1,
16238 NULL,
16239 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16240 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16241
16242 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
16243 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16244 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16245 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16246 an expression changes.\n\
16247 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16248 the memory to which it refers."));
16249 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16250
16251 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
16252 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16253 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16254 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16255 an expression is read.\n\
16256 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16257 the memory to which it refers."));
16258 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16259
16260 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
16261 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16262 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16263 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16264 an expression is either read or written.\n\
16265 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16266 the memory to which it refers."));
16267 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16268
16269 add_info ("watchpoints", watchpoints_info, _("\
16270 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
16271
16272 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
16273 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
16274 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
16275 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
16276 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16277 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16278 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
16279 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
16280 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
16281 hardware.)"),
16282 NULL,
16283 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
16284 &setlist, &showlist);
16285
16286 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
16287
16288 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
16289
16290 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
16291 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
16292 \n"
16293 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
16294 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16295 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16296
16297 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
16298 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16299 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16300 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16301
16302 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
16303 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
16304 \n"
16305 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
16306 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16307 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16308
16309 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
16310 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
16311 \n\
16312 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
16313 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
16314 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
16315 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
16316 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
16317 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
16318 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
16319 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
16320 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
16321 \n\
16322 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
16323 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
16324 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
16325 conditions are different.\n\
16326 \n\
16327 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
16328 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16329 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16330
16331 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
16332 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
16333 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
16334 last tracepoint set."));
16335
16336 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
16337
16338 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
16339 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
16340 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16341 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
16342 &deletelist);
16343 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
16344
16345 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
16346 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
16347 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16348 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
16349 &disablelist);
16350 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
16351
16352 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
16353 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
16354 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16355 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
16356 &enablelist);
16357 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
16358
16359 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
16360 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
16361 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
16362 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
16363 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
16364
16365 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
16366 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
16367 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
16368 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16369
16370 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
16371 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
16372 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
16373 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
16374 session to restore them."),
16375 &save_cmdlist);
16376 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16377
16378 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
16379 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
16380 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
16381 &save_cmdlist);
16382 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16383
16384 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
16385 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
16386
16387 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16388 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16389 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16390 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16391 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
16392 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
16393 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16394 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16395 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16396 pending breakpoint behavior"),
16397 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
16398 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
16399
16400 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
16401 &pending_break_support, _("\
16402 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16403 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16404 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
16405 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
16406 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
16407 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
16408 NULL,
16409 show_pending_break_support,
16410 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16411 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16412
16413 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
16414
16415 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
16416 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
16417 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16418 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16419 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
16420 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
16421 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
16422 NULL,
16423 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
16424 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16425 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16426
16427 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
16428 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
16429 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16430 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16431 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
16432 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
16433 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
16434 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
16435 when execution stops."),
16436 NULL,
16437 &show_always_inserted_mode,
16438 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16439 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16440
16441 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
16442 condition_evaluation_enums,
16443 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
16444 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16445 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16446 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
16447 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
16448 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
16449 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
16450 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
16451 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
16452 be set to \"gdb\""),
16453 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
16454 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
16455 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16456 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16457
16458 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
16459 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
16460 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
16461 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16462 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16463 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16464 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16465 or the start of the range\n\
16466 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16467 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16468 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16469 \n\
16470 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16471 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16472 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16473
16474 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16475 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
16476 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16477 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
16478 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
16479 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16480
16481 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16482 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16483 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16484 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16485 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16486 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16487 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16488 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16489 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16490 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16491 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16492 &setlist, &showlist);
16493
16494 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16495 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16496 &dprintf_function, _("\
16497 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16498 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16499 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16500 &setlist, &showlist);
16501
16502 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16503 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16504 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16505 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16506 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16507 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16508 &setlist, &showlist);
16509
16510 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16511 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16512 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16513 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16514 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16515 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16516 NULL,
16517 NULL,
16518 &setlist, &showlist);
16519
16520 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16521 agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
16522 (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16523
16524 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16525
16526 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16527 observer_attach_thread_exit (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
16528 }
This page took 0.369759 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.